blob: 45e2e06d734aaf58ccbad2fe28337aeb790d04ed [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7d1b48f2016-05-10 15:36:58 +02007 2016/05/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200566 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200568 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100569 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100570 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200572 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200573 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200574 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - noepoll
577 - nokqueue
578 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300580 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200581 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200582 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200583 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - tune.buffers.limit
585 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200586 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200587 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100588 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100589 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200590 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100591 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100592 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100593 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100594 - tune.lua.session-timeout
595 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200596 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100597 - tune.maxaccept
598 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200600 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200601 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100602 - tune.rcvbuf.client
603 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100604 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100605 - tune.sndbuf.client
606 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100607 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100608 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200609 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100610 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200611 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200612 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200613 - tune.vars.global-max-size
614 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
615 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
616 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100617 - tune.zlib.memlevel
618 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100619
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 * Debugging
621 - debug
622 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623
624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626------------------------------------
627
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200628ca-base <dir>
629 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200630 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
631 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633chroot <jail dir>
634 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
635 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
636 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
637 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
638 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
639 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100640
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100641cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
642 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
643 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
644 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100645 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
646 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
647 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
648 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
649 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
650 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
651 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
652 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
653 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
654 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100655
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200656crt-base <dir>
657 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
658 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
659 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661daemon
662 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
663 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
664 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
665
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200666deviceatlas-json-file <path>
667 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
668 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
669
670deviceatlas-log-level <value>
671 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
672 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
673
674deviceatlas-separator <char>
675 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
676 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
677
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100678deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200679 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
680 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
681 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100682
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900683external-check
684 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
685 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
686 See "option external-check".
687
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200688gid <number>
689 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
690 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
691 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100692 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
693 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696group <group name>
697 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
698 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100699
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200700log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
702 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100703 configured with "log global".
704
705 <address> can be one of:
706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100707 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100708 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
709 port).
710
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100711 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
712 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
713 port).
714
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100715 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
716 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
717 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
718 writeable).
719
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200720 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
721 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100722
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200723 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
724 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
725 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
726 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
727 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
728 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
729 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
730 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
731 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
732 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
733 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
734
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200735 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
736 one of the following :
737
738 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
739 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
740
741 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
742 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
743
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100744 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200745
746 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
747 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
748 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
749
750 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200751 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
752 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
753 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
754 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
755 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
756 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200758 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200759
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100760log-send-hostname [<string>]
761 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
762 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
763 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
764 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
765 the logs.
766
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000767log-tag <string>
768 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
769 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
770 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100771 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000772
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100773lua-load <file>
774 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
775 used multiple times.
776
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200777nbproc <number>
778 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
779 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
780 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
781 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
782 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
783
784pidfile <pidfile>
785 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
786 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
787 starting the process. See also "daemon".
788
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100789presetenv <name> <value>
790 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
791 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
792 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
793 and "unsetenv".
794
795resetenv [<name> ...]
796 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
797 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
798 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
799 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
800 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
801 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
802 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
803 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
804
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100805stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200806 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
807 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
808 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
809 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
810 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
811 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100812 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200813 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
814 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200815
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200816server-state-base <directory>
817 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200818 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
819 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200820
821server-state-file <file>
822 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
823 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
824 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
825 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
826 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
827 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
828 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
829 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200830 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
831 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200832
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100833setenv <name> <value>
834 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
835 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
836 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
837 and "unsetenv".
838
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100839ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
841 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300842 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100843 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
844 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
845 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
846 "bind" keyword for more information.
847
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100848ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
850 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
851 keyword to see available options.
852
853 Example:
854 global
855 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
856
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100857ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
859 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300860 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100861 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
862 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
863 information.
864
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100865ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
867 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
868 keyword to see available options.
869
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200870ssl-dh-param-file <file>
871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
872 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
873 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
874 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
875 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200876 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
877 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
878 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
879 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200880 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
881 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
882 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
883
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100884ssl-server-verify [none|required]
885 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
886 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
887 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
888
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200889stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
890 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
891 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
892 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200893 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
894 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200895
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200896 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
897 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
898 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200899
900stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
901 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
902 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100903 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200904
905stats maxconn <connections>
906 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
907 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200909uid <number>
910 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
911 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
912 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
913 one. See also "gid" and "user".
914
915ulimit-n <number>
916 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
917 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
918 option.
919
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100920unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
921 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
922
923 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
924 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
925 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
926 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
927 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
928 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
929 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
930 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
931 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
932 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
933
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100934unsetenv [<name> ...]
935 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
936 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
937 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
938 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
939 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
940 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
941 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
942
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200943user <user name>
944 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
945 See also "uid" and "group".
946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200947node <name>
948 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
949
950 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
951 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
952 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
953 traffic.
954
955description <text>
956 Add a text that describes the instance.
957
958 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
959 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
960 "<" and ">" characters.
961
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096251degrees-data-file <file path>
963 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
964 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
965
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200966 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100967 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
968
96951degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
970 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
971 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
972 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
973
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200974 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100975 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
976
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100978 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
979 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
980
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200981 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
982 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
983
98451degrees-cache-size <number>
985 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
986 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
987 By default, this cache is disabled.
988
989 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100990 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009933.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994-----------------------
995
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200996max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
997 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
998 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
999 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1000 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1001 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1002 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1003 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1004 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006maxconn <number>
1007 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1008 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1009 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001010 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1011 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1012 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1013 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001014 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1015 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1016 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1017 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1018 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001020maxconnrate <number>
1021 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1022 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1023 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1024 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1025 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1026 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1027 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1028 fairness.
1029
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001030maxcomprate <number>
1031 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001032 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001033 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1034 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1035 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1036 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1037 default value.
1038
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001039maxcompcpuusage <number>
1040 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1041 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1042 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1043 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1044 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1045 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1046 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1047 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1048
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001049maxpipes <number>
1050 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1051 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1052 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1053 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1054 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1055 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1056
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057maxsessrate <number>
1058 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1059 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1060 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1061 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1062 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1063 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1064 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1065 fairness.
1066
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001067maxsslconn <number>
1068 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1069 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1070 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1071 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1072 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1073 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1074 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001075 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1076 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1077 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1078 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1079 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1080 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1081 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001082
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001083maxsslrate <number>
1084 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1085 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1086 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1087 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1088 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1089 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1090 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1091 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1092 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1093 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1094
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001095maxzlibmem <number>
1096 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1097 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1098 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001099 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1100 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1101 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103noepoll
1104 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1105 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001106 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107
1108nokqueue
1109 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1110 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1111 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1112
1113nopoll
1114 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1115 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001116 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001117 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001119nosplice
1120 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1121 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1122 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001123 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001124 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1125 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1126 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1127 "option splice-response".
1128
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001129nogetaddrinfo
1130 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1131 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1132
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001133spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001134 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1135 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1136 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1137 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1138 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1139 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001140
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001141tune.buffers.limit <number>
1142 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1143 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1144 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1145 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1146 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1147 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1148 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1149 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1150 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1151 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1152 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1153 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1154 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1155 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1156 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1157
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001158tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1159 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1160 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1161 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1162 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1163
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001164tune.bufsize <number>
1165 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1166 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1167 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1168 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1169 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1170 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1171 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1172 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001173 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1174 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1175 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001176
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001177tune.chksize <number>
1178 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1179 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1180 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1181 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1182 checks whenever possible.
1183
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001184tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1185 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1186 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1187 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1188 this value. The default value is 1.
1189
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001190tune.http.cookielen <number>
1191 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1192 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1193 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1194 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1195 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1196 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1197 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1198 to change this value.
1199
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001200tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1201 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1202 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1203 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1204 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1205 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1206 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1207 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1208 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1209 limit too high.
1210
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001211tune.idletimer <timeout>
1212 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1213 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1214 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1215 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1216 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1217 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1218 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1219 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1220 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1221
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001222tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1223 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1224 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1225 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1226 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1227 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1228 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1229 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1230
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001231tune.lua.maxmem
1232 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1233 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1234 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1235 memory.
1236
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001237tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1238 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001239 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1240 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1241 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001242
1243tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1244 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1245 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1246 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1247 check servers.
1248
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001249tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1250 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1251 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1252 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1253 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1254
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001255tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001256 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1257 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1258 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1259 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1260 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1261 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1262 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1263 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1264 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1265 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001266
1267tune.maxpollevents <number>
1268 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1269 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1270 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1271 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1272 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1273
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001274tune.maxrewrite <number>
1275 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1276 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1277 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1278 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1279 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1280 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1281 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1282 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1283 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1284 bufsize.
1285
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001286tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1287 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1288 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1289 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1290 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1291 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1292 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1293 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1294 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1295 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1296 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1297 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1298 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1299 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1300 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1301 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1302 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1303 setting this parameter to 0.
1304
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001305tune.pipesize <number>
1306 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1307 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1308 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1309 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1310 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1311 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1312
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001313tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1314tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1315 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1316 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1317 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1318 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1319 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1320 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1321 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1322
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001323tune.recv_enough <number>
1324 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1325 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1326 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1327 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1328 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1329
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001330tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1331tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1332 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1333 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1334 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1335 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1336 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1337 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1338 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1339 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1340 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1341 notifying haproxy again.
1342
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001343tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001344 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1345 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1346 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001347 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001348 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1349 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1350 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1351 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1352 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001353 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1354 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001355
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001356tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1357 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1358 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1359 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1360 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1361 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1362 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1363
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001364tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1365 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001366 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001367 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1368 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1369 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1370 being used for too long.
1371
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001372tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1373 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1374 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1375 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1376 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1377 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1378 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1379 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1380 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1381 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1382 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001383 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1384 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001385
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001386tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1387 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1388 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1389 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1390 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1391 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1392 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1393 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001394 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1395 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001396
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001397tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1398 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1399 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1400 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1401 1000 entries.
1402
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001403tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1404tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1405tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1406tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001407 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1408 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1409 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1410 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1411 response processing.
1412 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1413 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1414 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001415
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001416 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1417 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1418 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1419 all available space is consumed.
1420 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1421 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1422 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001423
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001424tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1425 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001426 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001427 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1428 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1429 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1430
1431tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1432 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1433 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1434 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1435 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014373.3. Debugging
1438--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
1440debug
1441 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1442 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1443 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1444 system startup.
1445
1446quiet
1447 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1448 line argument "-q".
1449
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014513.4. Userlists
1452--------------
1453It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1454http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1455it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1456
1457userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001458 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001459 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1460
1461group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001462 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001463 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1464 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1465
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001466user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1467 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1469 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001470 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1471 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001472 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001473 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001474
1475
1476 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001477 userlist L1
1478 group G1 users tiger,scott
1479 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001480
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001481 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1482 user scott insecure-password elgato
1483 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001484
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001485 userlist L2
1486 group G1
1487 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001488
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001489 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1490 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1491 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001492
1493 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001494
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001495
14963.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001497----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001498It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1499several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1500instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1501values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1502automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1503In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1504using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1505tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1506reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1507Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1508that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1509each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001510
1511peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001512 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001513 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1514
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001515disabled
1516 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1517 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1518 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1519
1520enable
1521 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1522
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001523peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1524 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1525 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1526 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1527 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1528 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1529 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1530
1531 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1532 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1533
1534 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1535 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1536 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1537 across all peers.
1538
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001539 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1540 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001541
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001542 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001543 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001544 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1545 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1546 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001547
1548 backend mybackend
1549 mode tcp
1550 balance roundrobin
1551 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1552 stick on src
1553
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001554 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1555 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001556
1557
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015583.6. Mailers
1559------------
1560It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1561If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1562in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1563
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001564mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001565 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1566 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1567
1568mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1569 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1570
1571 Example:
1572 mailers mymailers
1573 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1574 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1575
1576 backend mybackend
1577 mode tcp
1578 balance roundrobin
1579
1580 email-alert mailers mymailers
1581 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1582 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1583
1584 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1585 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1586
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001587timeout mail <time>
1588 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1589 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1590 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1591 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1592
1593 Example:
1594 mailers mymailers
1595 timeout mail 20s
1596 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001599----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001601Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001602 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603 - frontend <name>
1604 - backend <name>
1605 - listen <name>
1606
1607A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1608its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1609section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611
1612A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1613connections.
1614
1615A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1616to forward incoming connections.
1617
1618A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1619parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001621All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1622'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1623case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1624
1625Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1626logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1627proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1628However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1629name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1630
1631Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1632and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001633bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001634protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1635modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1636arbitrary criteria.
1637
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001638In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1639a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1640the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1641
1642 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1643 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1644 between responses and new requests.
1645
1646 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1647 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1648 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1649 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1650
1651 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1652 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1653 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1654
1655 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1656 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1657 client-facing connection remains open.
1658
1659 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1660 after the end of the response.
1661
1662The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1663frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1664following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1665weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1666
1667 Backend mode
1668
1669 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1670 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1671 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1672 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1673 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1674 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1675 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1676 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1677 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1678 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1679 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016834.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1684--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001686The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1687limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1688they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1689limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001690marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001692and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1693with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1694specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001696
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001697 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1698------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1699acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001700appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001701backlog X X X -
1702balance X - X X
1703bind - X X -
1704bind-process X X X X
1705block - X X X
1706capture cookie - X X -
1707capture request header - X X -
1708capture response header - X X -
1709clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001710compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001711contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1712cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001713declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001714default-server X - X X
1715default_backend X X X -
1716description - X X X
1717disabled X X X X
1718dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001719email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001720email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001721email-alert mailers X X X X
1722email-alert myhostname X X X X
1723email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001724enabled X X X X
1725errorfile X X X X
1726errorloc X X X X
1727errorloc302 X X X X
1728-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1729errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001730force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001731filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001732fullconn X - X X
1733grace X X X X
1734hash-type X - X X
1735http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001736http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001737http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001738http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001739http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001740http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001741http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001742id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001743ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001744load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001745log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001746log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001747log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001748log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001749max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001750maxconn X X X -
1751mode X X X X
1752monitor fail - X X -
1753monitor-net X X X -
1754monitor-uri X X X -
1755option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1756option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1757option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1758option allbackups (*) X - X X
1759option checkcache (*) X - X X
1760option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1761option contstats (*) X X X -
1762option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1763option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1764option forceclose (*) X X X X
1765-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1766option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001767option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001768option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001769option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001770option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001771option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001772option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001773option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001774option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1775option httpchk X - X X
1776option httpclose (*) X X X X
1777option httplog X X X X
1778option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001779option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001780option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001781option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001782option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1783option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1784option logasap (*) X X X -
1785option mysql-check X - X X
1786option nolinger (*) X X X X
1787option originalto X X X X
1788option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001789option pgsql-check X - X X
1790option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001791option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001792option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001793option smtpchk X - X X
1794option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1795option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1796option splice-request (*) X X X X
1797option splice-response (*) X X X X
1798option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1799option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1800-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001801option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001802option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1803option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1804option tcpka X X X X
1805option tcplog X X X X
1806option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001807external-check command X - X X
1808external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001809persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1810rate-limit sessions X X X -
1811redirect - X X X
1812redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1813redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1814reqadd - X X X
1815reqallow - X X X
1816reqdel - X X X
1817reqdeny - X X X
1818reqiallow - X X X
1819reqidel - X X X
1820reqideny - X X X
1821reqipass - X X X
1822reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823reqitarpit - X X X
1824reqpass - X X X
1825reqrep - X X X
1826-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827reqtarpit - X X X
1828retries X - X X
1829rspadd - X X X
1830rspdel - X X X
1831rspdeny - X X X
1832rspidel - X X X
1833rspideny - X X X
1834rspirep - X X X
1835rsprep - X X X
1836server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001837server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001838source X - X X
1839srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001840stats admin - X X X
1841stats auth X X X X
1842stats enable X X X X
1843stats hide-version X X X X
1844stats http-request - X X X
1845stats realm X X X X
1846stats refresh X X X X
1847stats scope X X X X
1848stats show-desc X X X X
1849stats show-legends X X X X
1850stats show-node X X X X
1851stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001852-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1853stick match - - X X
1854stick on - - X X
1855stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001856stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001858tcp-check connect - - X X
1859tcp-check expect - - X X
1860tcp-check send - - X X
1861tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001862tcp-request connection - X X -
1863tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001864tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001865tcp-response content - - X X
1866tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001867timeout check X - X X
1868timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001869timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001870timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1871timeout connect X - X X
1872timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1873timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1874timeout http-request X X X X
1875timeout queue X - X X
1876timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001877timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001878timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1879timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001880timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001882unique-id-format X X X -
1883unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001884use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001885use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1887 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018904.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1891---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
1893This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1894
1895
1896acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1897 Declare or complete an access list.
1898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1899 no | yes | yes | yes
1900 Example:
1901 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1902 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1903 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906
1907
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001908appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1909 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1912 no | no | yes | yes
1913 Arguments :
1914 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1915 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1916
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001917 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918 checked in each cookie value.
1919
1920 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1921 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1922 milliseconds.
1923
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001924 request-learn
1925 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1926 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1927 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1928 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1929 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1930 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1931
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001932 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1933 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1934 data following this prefix.
1935
1936 Example :
1937 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1938
1939 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1940 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1941
1942 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1943 2 modes are currently supported :
1944 - path-parameters :
1945 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1946 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1947 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1948 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1949 - query-string :
1950 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1951 query string.
1952
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001953 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1954 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1955 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001957 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1958 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
1960
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001961backlog <conns>
1962 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1964 yes | yes | yes | no
1965 Arguments :
1966 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1967 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001968 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001969
1970 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1971 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1972 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1973 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1974 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1975 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1976 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1977 backlog parameter.
1978
1979 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1980 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1981 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1982
1983 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1984
1985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001987balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1990 yes | no | yes | yes
1991 Arguments :
1992 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1993 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1994 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1995 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1996
1997 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1998 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1999 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2000 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002001 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002002 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002003 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2004 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2005 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2006 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2007 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2008 it, so that you don't worry.
2009
2010 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2011 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2012 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2013 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2014 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2015 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2016 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2017 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002018
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002019 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2020 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2021 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2022 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2023 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2024 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2025 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2026 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2027
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002028 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002029 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002030 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2031 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002032 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002033 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2034 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2035 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2036 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2037 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002038 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2039 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2040 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2041 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2042 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2043 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2046 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2047 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2048 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2049 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2050 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2051 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2052 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002053 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002055 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2056 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2057 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002059 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2060 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2061 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2062 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2063 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2064 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2065 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2066 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2067 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2068 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2069 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2070 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002072 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002073 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2074 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2075 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2076 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2077 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2078 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2079 URIs start with a leading "/".
2080
2081 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2082 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2083 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2084 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002087 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2088
2089 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002090 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2091 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002092 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2093 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2094 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2095 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002097 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2098 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002099
2100 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2101 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2102 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2103 server will receive the request.
2104
2105 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2106 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2107 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2108 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2109 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002110 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2111 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2112 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002113
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002114 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2115 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2116 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2117 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2118 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002120 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002121 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2122 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2123 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2124
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002125 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2126 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2127 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2128
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002129 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002130 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002131 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2132 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2133 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2134 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2135 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2136 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002137 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002138 used instead.
2139
2140 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2141 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2142 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2143 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2144
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002145 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2146 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2147 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2148
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002149 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002152 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2153 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002154
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002155 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2156 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2157 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158
2159 Examples :
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002162 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002163 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2164 balance hdr(host)
2165 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002166
2167 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2168 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002170 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002171 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2172 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2173 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2174 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2175
2176 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2177 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2178 defaults to 16 kB.
2179
2180 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2181 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2182
2183 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2184 Round Robin.
2185
2186 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2187 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2188 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2189 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2190
2191 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2192
2193 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002194 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002195 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2196 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2197 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002199 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200
2201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002202bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2203bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2206 no | yes | yes | no
2207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002208 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2209 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2210 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2211 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002212 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002213 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2214 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2215 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2216 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2217 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2218 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2219 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002220 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2221 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2222 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2223 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2224 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2225 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2226 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002227 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2228 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2229 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002230 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2231 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2232 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002233
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002234 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2235 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002236 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2237 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2238 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002239 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2240 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2241 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2242 the range.
2243
2244 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2245 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2246 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2247 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2248 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2249 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2250 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002251 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002252 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002253
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002254 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2255 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2256 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2257 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2258 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2259 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2260 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2261 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2262
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002263 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2264 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2265 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2266 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2269 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2270 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2271 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2272 in a frontend.
2273
2274 Example :
2275 listen http_proxy
2276 bind :80,:443
2277 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002278 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002280 listen http_https_proxy
2281 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002282 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002283
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002284 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2285 bind ipv6@:80
2286 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2287 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2288
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002289 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002290 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002291
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002292 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2293 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2294 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2295 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2296 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2297
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002298 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002299 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
2301
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002302bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002303 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2305 yes | yes | yes | yes
2306 Arguments :
2307 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2308 may be used to override a default value.
2309
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002310 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002311 option may be combined with other numbers.
2312
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002313 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002314 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2315 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2316 missing from all processes.
2317
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002318 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002319 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002320 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2321 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2322 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2323 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002324
2325 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2326 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2327 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2328 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2329 and 'even' instances.
2330
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002331 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2332 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2333 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2334 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002335
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002336 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2337 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2338
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002339 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2340 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2341 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2342
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002343 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2344 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2345
2346 Example :
2347 listen app_ip1
2348 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002349 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002350
2351 listen app_ip2
2352 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002353 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002354
2355 listen management
2356 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002357 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002358
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002359 listen management
2360 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2361 bind-process 1-4
2362
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002363 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002364
2365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366block { if | unless } <condition>
2367 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 no | yes | yes | yes
2370
2371 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2372 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002373 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002374 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2376 "block" statements per instance.
2377
2378 Example:
2379 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2380 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2381 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2382 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002384 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385
2386
2387capture cookie <name> len <length>
2388 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2390 no | yes | yes | no
2391 Arguments :
2392 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2393 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2394 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2395 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2396 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2397
2398 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2399 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2400 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2401 right if it exceeds <length>.
2402
2403 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2404 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2405 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2406 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2407
2408 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2409 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2410 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2411
2412 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2413 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2414 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002415 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2416 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2417 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418
2419 Example:
2420 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2421
2422 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002423 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
2425
2426capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002427 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2429 no | yes | yes | no
2430 Arguments :
2431 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002432 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2434 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2435 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2436
2437 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2438 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2439 it exceeds <length>.
2440
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002441 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2443 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002444 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2445 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2446 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2447 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002448 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002449 environments to find where the request came from.
2450
2451 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2452 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2453 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2454 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002456 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2457 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2458 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2459 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2460 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
2462 Example:
2463 capture request header Host len 15
2464 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002465 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002467 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 about logging.
2469
2470
2471capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002472 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2474 no | yes | yes | no
2475 Arguments :
2476 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002477 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2479 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2480 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2481
2482 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2483 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2484 it exceeds <length>.
2485
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002486 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002487 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2488 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2489 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002490 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2491 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2492 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2493 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002495 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2496 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2497 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2498 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2499 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002500
2501 Example:
2502 capture response header Content-length len 9
2503 capture response header Location len 15
2504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002505 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506 about logging.
2507
2508
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002509clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | yes | yes | no
2513 Arguments :
2514 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2515 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2516 as explained at the top of this document.
2517
2518 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2519 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2520 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2521 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2522 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2523 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2524 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2525 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002526 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2528 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2529
2530 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2531 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2532 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2533 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2534 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2535 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2536
2537 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2538 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2539
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002540 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2541 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002543compression algo <algorithm> ...
2544compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002545compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002546 Enable HTTP compression.
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 yes | yes | yes | yes
2549 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002550 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2551 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2552 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2553
2554 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002555 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2556 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2557 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002559 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002560 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002561
2562 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2563 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2564 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2565 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2566 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002567 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002568
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002569 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2570 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2571 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2572 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2573 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2574 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2575 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002576 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002577
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002578 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002579 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002580 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2581 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2582 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2583 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2584 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002585
2586 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2587 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2588 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2589 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2590 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002591 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2592 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2593 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2594 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2595 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002596 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2597 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002598
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002599 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002600 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2601 "Accept-Encoding" header
2602 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002603 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002604 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2605 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002606 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2607 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2608 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2609 "multipart"
2610 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2611 header
2612 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2613 and later
2614 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2615 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002616
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002617 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2618 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002619
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002620 Examples :
2621 compression algo gzip
2622 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002624
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002625contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2628 yes | no | yes | yes
2629 Arguments :
2630 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2631 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2632 as explained at the top of this document.
2633
2634 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002635 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002636 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2638 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2639 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2640 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2641
2642 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2643 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2644 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2645 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2646 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2647 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2648
2649 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2650 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2651 instead.
2652
2653 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2654 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2655
2656
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002657cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002658 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2659 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 yes | no | yes | yes
2663 Arguments :
2664 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2665 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2666 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2667 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2668 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2669 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2670 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2671 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2672 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2673
2674 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2675 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2676 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2677 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2678 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2679 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002680 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2681 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2682 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2683 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2684 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002685
2686 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002687 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002688
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002689 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002690 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2691 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2692 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2693 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2694 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2695 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2696 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2697 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2698 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2699 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
2701 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2702 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2703 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2704 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2705 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2706 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2707 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2708 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2709 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002710 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002711 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2712 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2713 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002715 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2716 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2717 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002718 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2719 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2720 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2721 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002722 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2723 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2724 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
2726 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2727 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2728 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2729 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2730 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2731 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2732 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2733 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2734 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2735
2736 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2737 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2738 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2739 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2740 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2741 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2742 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2743 persistence cookie in the cache.
2744 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2745
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002746 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2747 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2748 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2749 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2750 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2751 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2752 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2753 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2754 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2755 they logout.
2756
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002757 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2758 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2759 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2760 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2761
2762 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2763 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2764 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2765 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2766 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2767 this attribute.
2768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002769 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002770 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002771 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2772 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2773 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2774 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2775 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2776 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002777
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002778 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2779 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2780 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2781 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2782 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2783 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2784 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2785 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2786 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2787 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2788 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2789 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2790 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2791 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2792 the site.
2793
2794 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2795 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2796 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2797 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2798 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2799 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2800 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2801 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2802 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2803 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2804 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2805 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2806 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2807 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2808 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2809 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2812 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2813 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2814 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 Examples :
2817 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2818 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2819 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002820 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002822 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002824
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002825declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2826 Declares a capture slot.
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 no | yes | yes | no
2829 Arguments:
2830 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2831
2832 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2833 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2834 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2835 for use in the response.
2836
2837 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002838 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002839 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2840
2841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002842default-server [param*]
2843 Change default options for a server in a backend
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | no | yes | yes
2846 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002847 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2848 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2849 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2850 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002851
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002852 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002853 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2854
2855 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858default_backend <backend>
2859 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2861 yes | yes | yes | no
2862 Arguments :
2863 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2864
2865 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2866 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2867 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2868 will catch all undetermined requests.
2869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870 Example :
2871
2872 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2873 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2874 default_backend dynamic
2875
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002876 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002879description <string>
2880 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 no | yes | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : string
2884
2885 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2886 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2887 it describes.
2888 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2889
2890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891disabled
2892 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | yes | yes | yes
2895 Arguments : none
2896
2897 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2898 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2899 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2900 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2901 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2902 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2903 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2904
2905 See also : "enabled"
2906
2907
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002908dispatch <address>:<port>
2909 Set a default server address
2910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2911 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002913
2914 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2915 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2916 during start-up.
2917
2918 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2919 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2920 possible with normal servers.
2921
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002922 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002923 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2924 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2925 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2926 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2927
2928 See also : "server"
2929
2930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931enabled
2932 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | yes
2935 Arguments : none
2936
2937 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2938 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2939
2940 See also : "disabled"
2941
2942
2943errorfile <code> <file>
2944 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | yes | yes | yes
2947 Arguments :
2948 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002949 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2950 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
2952 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002953 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002955 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2956 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
2958 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2959 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2960 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2961
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002962 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2965 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2966 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2967 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2968
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002969 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2970 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2971 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2972 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2973 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2974 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2977 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2978 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002979 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002980 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2981
2982 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2983
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002984 Example :
2985 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002986 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002987 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2988 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002990
2991errorloc <code> <url>
2992errorloc302 <code> <url>
2993 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2995 yes | yes | yes | yes
2996 Arguments :
2997 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002998 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002999
3000 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3001 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3002 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3003 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3004 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3005
3006 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3007 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3008 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3009
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003010 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003012 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3013 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3014 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3015 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003016 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003017 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3018 request.
3019
3020 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3021
3022
3023errorloc303 <code> <url>
3024 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3026 yes | yes | yes | yes
3027 Arguments :
3028 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3029 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3030
3031 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3032 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3033 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3034 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3035 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3036
3037 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3038 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3039 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3040
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003041 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3042
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003043 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3044 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3045 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3046 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003047 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003048
3049 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3050
3051
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003052email-alert from <emailaddr>
3053 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3054 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 yes | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 Arguments :
3059
3060 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3061
3062 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3063 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3064
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003065 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003066 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3067 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003068
3069
3070email-alert level <level>
3071 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3072 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | yes | yes | yes
3075
3076 Arguments :
3077
3078 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3079 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3080 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3081
3082 By default level is alert
3083
3084 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3085 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3086 for the proxy.
3087
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003088 Alerts are sent when :
3089
3090 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3091 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3092 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3093 is notice or lower
3094 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3095 and a health check status update occurs
3096
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003097 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3098 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003099 section 3.6 about mailers.
3100
3101
3102email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3103 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3104 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3105 yes | yes | yes | yes
3106
3107 Arguments :
3108
3109 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3110
3111 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3112 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3113
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003114 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3115 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003116
3117
3118email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3119 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3120 mailers.
3121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3122 yes | yes | yes | yes
3123
3124 Arguments :
3125
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003126 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003127
3128 By default the systems hostname is used.
3129
3130 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3131 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3132 for the proxy.
3133
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003134 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3135 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003136
3137
3138email-alert to <emailaddr>
3139 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3140 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143
3144 Arguments :
3145
3146 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3147
3148 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3149 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3150
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003151 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003152 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3153
3154
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003155force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3156 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3158 no | yes | yes | yes
3159
3160 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3161 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3162 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3163 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3164 marked down for maintenance operations.
3165
3166 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3167 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3168 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3169 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3170 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3171 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3172 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3173 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3174 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3175
3176 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3177 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3178 is used.
3179
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003180 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003181 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003182
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003183
3184filter <name> [param*]
3185 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 no | yes | yes | yes
3188 Arguments :
3189 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3190 referenced in section 9.
3191
3192 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3193 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3194 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3195 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3196
3197 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3198 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3199
3200 Example:
3201 listen
3202 bind *:80
3203
3204 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3205 filter compression
3206 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3207
3208 compression algo gzip
3209 compression offload
3210
3211 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3212
3213 See also : section 9.
3214
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216fullconn <conns>
3217 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3219 yes | no | yes | yes
3220 Arguments :
3221 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3222 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3223
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003224 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003225 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003226 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003227 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3228 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3229 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3230 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3231 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003232 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003233
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003234 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3235 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003236 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3237 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3238 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003239
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003240 Example :
3241 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3242 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3243 # connections.
3244 backend dynamic
3245 fullconn 10000
3246 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3247 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3248
3249 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3250
3251
3252grace <time>
3253 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003255 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003256 Arguments :
3257 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3258 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3259 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3260
3261 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3262 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003263 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003264 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3265
3266 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3267 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3268 simplify it.
3269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003270
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003271hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003272 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3274 yes | no | yes | yes
3275 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003276 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3277 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003278
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003279 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3280 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3281 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3282 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3283 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3284 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3285 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3286 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3287 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3288 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003289
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003290 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3291 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3292 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3293 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3294 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3295 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3296 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3297 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3298 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3299 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3300 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3301 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3302 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003303 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3304 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003305
3306 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3307
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003308 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003309 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3310 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3311 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003312 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3313 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3314 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003315
3316 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3317 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003318 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3319 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3320 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3321 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3322
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003323 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3324 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3325 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3326 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3327 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3328 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3329 parameter.
3330
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003331 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3332 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3333 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3334 used on strings.
3335
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003336 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3337
3338 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3339 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3340 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3341 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3342 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3343 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3344 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3345 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3346 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3347 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3348 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3349 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003350
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003351 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3352 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3353 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003354
3355 See also : "balance", "server"
3356
3357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358http-check disable-on-404
3359 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362 Arguments : none
3363
3364 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3365 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3366 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3367 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3368 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3369 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3370 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3371 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003372 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3373 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3374 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3375
3376 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3377
3378
3379http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003380 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003382 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003383 Arguments :
3384 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3385 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003386 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003387 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3388 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3389 details on the supported keywords.
3390
3391 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3392 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3393 with the usual backslash ('\').
3394
3395 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3396 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3397 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3398 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3399 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3400
3401 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003402 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003403 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3404 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3405 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3406
3407 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003409 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3410 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3411 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3412 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3413
3414 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003415 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003416 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3417 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3418 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3419 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3420 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3421 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3422 trace).
3423
3424 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003425 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003426 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3427 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3428 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3429 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3430 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3431 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3432
3433 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3434 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3435 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3436 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3437 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3438 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3439 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3440 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3441
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003442 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3443 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3444 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3445
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003446 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3447 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3448
3449 Examples :
3450 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003451 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003452
3453 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003454 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003455
3456 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003457 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003458
3459 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003460 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003462 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003463
3464
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003465http-check send-state
3466 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 yes | no | yes | yes
3469 Arguments : none
3470
3471 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3472 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3473 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3474 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3475 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3476
3477 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3478 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3479 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3480 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3481 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003482 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3483 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3484 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3485
3486 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3487 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3488 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3489
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003490 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3491 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3492 checked in multiple backends.
3493
3494 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3495 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3496
3497 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3498 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3499 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3500 one fails.
3501
3502 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3503 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3504 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3505
3506 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3507 server's queue.
3508
3509 Example of a header received by the application server :
3510 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3511 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3512
3513 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3514
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003515http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003516 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003517 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003518 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003519 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3520 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003521 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3522 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003523 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3524 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3525 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003526 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003527 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003528 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003529 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003530 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003531 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003532 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003533 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003534 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3535
3536 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3537 no | yes | yes | yes
3538
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003539 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3540 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3541 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3542 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3543 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003544
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003545 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3546 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3547 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3548
3549 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3550 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3551 are evaluated.
3552
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003553 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3554 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3555 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3556 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3557 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3558 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3559 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3560 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3561 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003562 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003563 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3564 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003565
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003566 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3567 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3568 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3569 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3570 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3571
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003572 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3573 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3574 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003575 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3576 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003577
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003578 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3579 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3580 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3581 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3582 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3583 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3584 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3585 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3586
3587 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3588 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3589 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003590 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3591 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003592
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003593 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3594 <name>.
3595
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003596 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3597 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3598 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3599 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3600 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3601 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3602 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3603 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3604
3605 Example:
3606
3607 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3608
3609 applied to:
3610
3611 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3612
3613 outputs:
3614
3615 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3616
3617 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3618
3619 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3620 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3621 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3622 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3623 header.
3624
3625 Example:
3626
3627 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3628
3629 applied to:
3630
3631 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3632
3633 outputs:
3634
3635 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3636
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003637 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3638 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3639 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3640 it.
3641
3642 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3643 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3644 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3645 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3646 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3647 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3648
3649 Example :
3650 # prepend the host name before the path
3651 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3652
3653 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3654 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3655 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3656 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3657 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3658 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3659 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3660 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3661
3662 Example :
3663 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3664 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3665
3666 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3667 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3668 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3669 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3670 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3671 "set-query".
3672
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003673 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3674 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3675 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3676 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3677 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3678 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3679 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3680 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3681
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003682 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3683 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3684 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3685 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3686 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3687 another equipment.
3688
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003689 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3690 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3691 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3692 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3693 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3694 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3695 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3696 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3697
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003698 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3699 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3700 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3701 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3702 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3703 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3704 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3705 admin privileges.
3706
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003707 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3708 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3709 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3710 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3711 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3712 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3713 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3714 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3715
3716 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3717 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3718 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3719 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3720 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3721 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3722
3723 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3724 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3725 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3726 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3727 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3728 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3729
3730 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3731 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3732 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3733 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3734 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3735 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3736 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3737 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3738 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3739
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003740 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003741 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3742 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3743 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3744 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3745 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3746 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3747 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3748 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3749 request header" for more information.
3750
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003751 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3752 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3753 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3754 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003755 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3756 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003757
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003758 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3759 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3760 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3761 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3762 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3763 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3764 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3765 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3766 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3767 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3768 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3769 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3770
3771 These actions take one or two arguments :
3772 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3773 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3774 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3775 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3776
3777 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3778 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3779 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3780 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3781
3782 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3783 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3784 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3785 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3786 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3787 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3788 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3789 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3790
3791 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3792 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3793 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3794 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3795 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3796
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003797 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3798 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3799 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3800 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3801 continues.
3802
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003803 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3804 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3805 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3806 the actions evaluation continues.
3807
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003808 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3809 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3810 inline.
3811
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003812 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3813 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3814 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3815 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003816 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003817 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003818 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003819 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3820 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003821 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003822 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003823 and '_'.
3824
3825 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3826 followed by some converters.
3827
3828 Example:
3829
3830 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3831
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003832 - set-src <expr> :
3833 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3834 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3835 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3836 source IP for privacy.
3837
3838 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3839 followed by some converters.
3840
3841 Example:
3842
3843 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3844 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3845
3846 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3847
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003848 - set-src-port <expr> :
3849 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3850 expression.
3851
3852 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3853 followed by some converters.
3854
3855 Example:
3856
3857 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3858 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3859
3860 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
3861 the source port to 0.
3862
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003863 - set-dst <expr> :
3864 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3865 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3866 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3867 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3868 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3869
3870 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3871 followed by some converters.
3872
3873 Example:
3874
3875 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
3876 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
3877
3878 - set-dst-port <expr> :
3879 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
3880 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3881 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3882
3883 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3884 followed by some converters.
3885
3886 Example:
3887
3888 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
3889 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
3890
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003891 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3892 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3893 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3894 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3895 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3896 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3897 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3898 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3899 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3900 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3901 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3902 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3903 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3904 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3905 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3906 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3907
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003908 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3909
3910 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3911 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003912 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3913 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3914
3915 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3916 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3917 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3918 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003919
3920 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003921 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3922 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3923 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003924
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003925 http-request allow if nagios
3926 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3927 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3928 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003929
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003930 Example:
3931 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003932 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003933
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003934 Example:
3935 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3936 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003937 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003938 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3939 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3940 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3941 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3942 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3943 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3944
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003945 Example:
3946 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3947 acl add path /addacl
3948 acl del path /delacl
3949
3950 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3951
3952 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3953 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3954
3955 Example:
3956 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3957 acl setmap path /setmap
3958 acl delmap path /delmap
3959
3960 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3961
3962 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3963 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3964
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003965 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3966 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003967
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003968http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003969 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003970 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003971 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3972 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003973 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003974 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3975 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3976 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3977 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003978 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003979 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003980 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003981 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003982 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003983 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003984 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003985 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3986
3987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3988 no | yes | yes | yes
3989
3990 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3991 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3992 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3993 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3994 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3995 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3996
3997 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3998 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3999 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4000 current section.
4001
4002 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4003 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4004 rules are evaluated.
4005
4006 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4007 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4008 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4009 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4010 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4011 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4012 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4013
4014 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4015 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4016 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4017 external users.
4018
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004019 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4020 <name>.
4021
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004022 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4023 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4024 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4025 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4026 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4027 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4028 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4029 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4030
4031 Example:
4032
4033 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4034
4035 applied to:
4036
4037 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4038
4039 outputs:
4040
4041 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4042
4043 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4044
4045 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4046 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4047 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4048 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4049 header.
4050
4051 Example:
4052
4053 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4054
4055 applied to:
4056
4057 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4058
4059 outputs:
4060
4061 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4062
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004063 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4064 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4065 adapted to the new code.
4066
4067 Example:
4068
4069 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4070 http-response set-status 431
4071
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004072 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4073 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4074 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4075 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4076 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4077 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4078 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4079 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4080
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004081 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4082 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4083 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4084 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4085 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4086 another equipment.
4087
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004088 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4089 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4090 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4091 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4092 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4093 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4094 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4095 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4096
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004097 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4098 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4099 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4100 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4101 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4102 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4103 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4104 admin privileges.
4105
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004106 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4107 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4108 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4109 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4110 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4111 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4112 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4113 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4114
4115 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4116 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4117 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4118 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4119 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4120 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4121
4122 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4123 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4124 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4125 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4126 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4127 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4128
4129 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4130 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4131 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4132 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4133 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4134 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4135 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4136 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4137 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4138
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004139 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4140 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4141 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4142 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4143 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4144 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4145 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4146 response header" for more information.
4147
4148 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4149 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4150 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4151 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4152 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004153 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4154 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004155
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004156 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4157 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4158 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4159 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4160 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4161 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4162
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004163 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4164 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4165 inline.
4166
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004167 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4168 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4169 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4170 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004171 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004172 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004173 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004174 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4175 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004176 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004177 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004178 and '_'.
4179
4180 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4181 followed by some converters.
4182
4183 Example:
4184
4185 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4186
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004187 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4188 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4189 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4190 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4191 continues.
4192
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004193 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4194 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4195 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4196 the actions evaluation continues.
4197
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004198 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4199 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4200 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4201 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4202 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4203 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4204 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4205 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4206 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4207 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4208 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4209 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4210 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4211 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4212 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4213 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4214
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004215 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4216
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004217 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004218 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4219 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004220 rules.
4221
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004222 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4223 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4224 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4225 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4226
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004227 Example:
4228 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4229
4230 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4231
4232 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4233 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4234
4235 Example:
4236 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4237
4238 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4239
4240 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4241 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4242
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004243 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4244 ACL usage.
4245
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004246
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004247http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4248 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4249
4250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4251 yes | no | yes | yes
4252
4253 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4254 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4255 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4256 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4257 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4258 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4259
4260 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4261
4262 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4263 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4264 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4265 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4266 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4267 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4268 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4269 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4270 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4271 not checking any request past the first one.
4272
4273 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4274 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4275 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4276 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4277 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4278 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4279 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4280
4281 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4282 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4283 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4284 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4285 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4286 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4287 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4288 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4289 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4290 downsides of rare connection failures.
4291
4292 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4293 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4294 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4295 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4296 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4297 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4298 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4299 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4300 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4301 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4302 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4303 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4304
4305 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4306 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4307 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4308 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4309
4310 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4311 and are never shared ;
4312
4313 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4314 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4315 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4316 and are never shared ;
4317
4318 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4319 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4320 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4321
4322 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4323 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4324 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4325
4326 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4327
4328
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004329http-send-name-header [<header>]
4330 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4331
4332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4333 yes | no | yes | yes
4334
4335 Arguments :
4336
4337 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4338
4339 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4340 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4341 is added with the header string proved.
4342
4343 See also : "server"
4344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004345id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004346 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4348 no | yes | yes | yes
4349 Arguments : none
4350
4351 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4352 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4353 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004354
4355
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004356ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4357 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4358 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4359 no | yes | yes | yes
4360
4361 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4362 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4363 and running).
4364
4365 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4366 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4367 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004368 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004369 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4370
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004371 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4372 "unless" condition is met.
4373
4374 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4375
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004376load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4377 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | no | yes | yes
4380
4381 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4382 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4383 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4384 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4385 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4386 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4387 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4388 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4389
4390 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4391 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004392 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004393
4394 Arguments:
4395 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4396 named "server-state-file".
4397
4398 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4399 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4400 name is used as a file name.
4401
4402 none don't load any stat for this backend
4403
4404 Notes:
4405 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4406 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4407 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4408
4409 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4410 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4411
4412 Example 1:
4413
4414 Minimal configuration:
4415
4416 global
4417 stats socket /tmp/socket
4418 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4419
4420 defaults
4421 load-server-state-from-file global
4422
4423 backend bk
4424 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4425 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4426
4427 Then one can run :
4428
4429 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4430
4431 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4432
4433 1
4434 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4435 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4436 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4437
4438 Example 2:
4439
4440 Minimal configuration:
4441
4442 global
4443 stats socket /tmp/socket
4444 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4445
4446 defaults
4447 load-server-state-from-file local
4448
4449 backend bk
4450 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4451 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4452
4453 Then one can run :
4454
4455 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4456
4457 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4458
4459 1
4460 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4461 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4462 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4463
4464 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4465 "show servers state"
4466
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004468log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004469log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004470no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004471 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4473 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004474
4475 Prefix :
4476 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4477 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4478 prefix does not allow arguments.
4479
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004480 Arguments :
4481 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4482 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4483 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4484 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4485 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4486 parameter.
4487
4488 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4489 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4490
4491 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4492 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4493 standard syslog port).
4494
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004495 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4496 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4497 standard syslog port).
4498
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004499 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4500 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4501 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4502 appropriately writeable).
4503
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004504 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4505 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004506
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004507 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4508 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4509 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4510 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4511 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4512 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4513 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4514 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4515 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4516 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4517 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4518
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004519 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4520
4521 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4522 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4523 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4524
4525 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4526 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4527 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004528 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4529 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4530 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4531 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4532 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004533
4534 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4535
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004536 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4537 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4538 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004539
4540 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4541 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4542 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4543 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4544
4545 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4546 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004547
4548 Example :
4549 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004550 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4551 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004552 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004553
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004554
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004555log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004556 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004559
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004560 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4561 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4562 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4563 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4564 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004565
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004566log-format-sd <string>
4567 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4568 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4569 yes | yes | yes | no
4570
4571 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4572 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4573 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4574 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4575 which covers the log format string in depth.
4576
4577 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4578 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4579
4580 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4581 log format to "rfc5424".
4582
4583 Example :
4584 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4585
4586
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004587log-tag <string>
4588 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4589 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4590 yes | yes | yes | yes
4591
4592 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4593 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4594 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4595 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4596 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4597 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4598 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4599 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4600 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004601
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004602max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4603 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4604 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4605 yes | no | yes | yes
4606
4607 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4608 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4609 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4610 servers.
4611
4612 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4613 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4614 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4615 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4616 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4617 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4618 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4619 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4620 picking a different server.
4621
4622 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4623 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4624 even if they have to be queued.
4625
4626 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4627 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4628
4629
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004630maxconn <conns>
4631 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4633 yes | yes | yes | no
4634 Arguments :
4635 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4636 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4637 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4638 closes.
4639
4640 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4641 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4642 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4643 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004644 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4645 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4646 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4647 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004648
4649 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4650 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4651 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4652
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004653 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4654
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004655 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4656
4657
4658mode { tcp|http|health }
4659 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 yes | yes | yes | yes
4662 Arguments :
4663 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4664 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4665 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4666 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4667
4668 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4669 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4670 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4671 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4672 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4673
4674 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004675 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4676 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4677 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4678 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4679 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4680 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4681 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004682
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004683 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4684 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4685 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004686
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004687 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004688 defaults http_instances
4689 mode http
4690
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004691 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004692
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004693
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004694monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004695 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4697 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004698 Arguments :
4699 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4700 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004701 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004702 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4703 backend and its backup.
4704
4705 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4706 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4707 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4708 servers in a list of backends.
4709
4710 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4711 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4712 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4713 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4714 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4715 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4716 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004717 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4718 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004719
4720 Example:
4721 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004722 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004723 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4724 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4725 monitor-uri /site_alive
4726 monitor fail if site_dead
4727
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004728 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004729
4730
4731monitor-net <source>
4732 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4734 yes | yes | yes | no
4735 Arguments :
4736 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4737 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4738 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4739 followed by a mask.
4740
4741 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4742 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004743 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004744 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4745
4746 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4747 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4748 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4749 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004750 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4751 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4752 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004753
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004754 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4755 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4756 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4757 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4758 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4759 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004760
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004761 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4762 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004763
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004764 Example :
4765 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4766 frontend www
4767 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4768
4769 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4770
4771
4772monitor-uri <uri>
4773 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4775 yes | yes | yes | no
4776 Arguments :
4777 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4778 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4779
4780 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4781 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4782 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4783 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4784 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4785 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4786 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4787 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4788
4789 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4790 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4791 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4792 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4793 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4794 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4795
4796 Example :
4797 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4798 frontend www
4799 mode http
4800 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4801
4802 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004804
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004805option abortonclose
4806no option abortonclose
4807 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | no | yes | yes
4810 Arguments : none
4811
4812 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4813 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4814 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4815 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004816 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004817 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4818 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4819 encountered while delivering the response.
4820
4821 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4822 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4823 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4824 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4825 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4826 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004827 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004828 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004829 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004830 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4831 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4832 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4833
4834 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4835 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4836 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4837 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4838 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4839 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4840 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4841 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004842 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004843
4844 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4845 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4846
4847 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4848
4849
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004850option accept-invalid-http-request
4851no option accept-invalid-http-request
4852 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4854 yes | yes | yes | no
4855 Arguments : none
4856
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004857 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004858 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4859 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4860 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4861 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4862 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4863 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4864 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004865 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4866 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4867 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4868 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4869 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004870 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004871 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4872 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4873 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004874
4875 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4876 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4877 been confirmed.
4878
4879 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4880 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004881 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4882 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004883 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4884
4885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4887
4888 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4889 stats socket.
4890
4891
4892option accept-invalid-http-response
4893no option accept-invalid-http-response
4894 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4896 yes | no | yes | yes
4897 Arguments : none
4898
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004899 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004900 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4901 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4902 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4903 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4904 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4905 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4906 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004907 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4908 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4909 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004910
4911 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4912 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4913 been confirmed.
4914
4915 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4916 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4917 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4918 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4919
4920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4922
4923 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4924 stats socket.
4925
4926
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004927option allbackups
4928no option allbackups
4929 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4931 yes | no | yes | yes
4932 Arguments : none
4933
4934 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4935 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4936 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4937 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4938 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4939 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4940 order between the backup servers anymore.
4941
4942 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4943 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4944
4945 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4946 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4947
4948
4949option checkcache
4950no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004951 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4953 yes | no | yes | yes
4954 Arguments : none
4955
4956 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4957 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004958 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004959 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4960 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004961 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004962
4963 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004964 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004965 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004966 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4967 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004968 to the client are :
4969 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004970 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004971 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004972 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4973 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4974 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4975 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4976 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4977 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4978 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4979 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4980 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4981 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4982 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4983
4984 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004985 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004986 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004987 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004988 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4989
4990 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4991 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004992 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004993 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4994
4995 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4996 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4997
4998
4999option clitcpka
5000no option clitcpka
5001 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5003 yes | yes | yes | no
5004 Arguments : none
5005
5006 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5007 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5008 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5009 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5010
5011 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5012 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5013 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5014 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5015
5016 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5017 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5018 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5019 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5020 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5021
5022 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5023
5024 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5025 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5026 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5027
5028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5030
5031 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5032
5033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005034option contstats
5035 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | no
5038 Arguments : none
5039
5040 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5041 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5042 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5043 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5044 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5045 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5046 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5047
5048
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005049option dontlog-normal
5050no option dontlog-normal
5051 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5053 yes | yes | yes | no
5054 Arguments : none
5055
5056 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5057 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5058 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5059 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5060 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5061 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5062 logged.
5063
5064 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5065 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5066 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005068 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005069 logging.
5070
5071
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005072option dontlognull
5073no option dontlognull
5074 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5076 yes | yes | yes | no
5077 Arguments : none
5078
5079 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5080 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5081 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5082 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5083 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5084 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005085 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5086 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5087 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005088
5089 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5090 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5091 would not be logged.
5092
5093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5095
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005096 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5097 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005098
5099
5100option forceclose
5101no option forceclose
5102 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005104 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005105 Arguments : none
5106
5107 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5108 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5109 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5110 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5111 global session times in the logs.
5112
5113 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005114 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005115 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005116
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005117 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5118 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5119 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5120
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005121 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5122 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005123
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005124 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5125 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5126
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005127 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005128
5129
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005130option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005131 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5133 yes | yes | yes | yes
5134 Arguments :
5135 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5136 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005137 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005138 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005139
5140 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5141 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5142 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5143 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5144 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5145 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5146 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005147 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5148 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5149 possible that the client has already brought one.
5150
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005151 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005152 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005153 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5154 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005155 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5156 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005157
5158 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5159 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5160 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5161 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5162 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5163 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5164 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5165
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005166 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5167 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5168 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5169 are under the control of the end-user.
5170
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005171 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005172 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5173 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005174 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5175 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5176 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005177
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005178 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005179 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5180 frontend www
5181 mode http
5182 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5183
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005184 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5185 backend www
5186 mode http
5187 option forwardfor header X-Client
5188
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005189 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005190 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005191
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005192
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005193option http-buffer-request
5194no option http-buffer-request
5195 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5197 yes | yes | yes | yes
5198 Arguments : none
5199
5200 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5201 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5202 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5203 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5204 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5205 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5206 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5207 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5208 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5209 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5210 default.
5211
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005212 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005213
5214
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005215option http-ignore-probes
5216no option http-ignore-probes
5217 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | yes | yes | no
5220 Arguments : none
5221
5222 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5223 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5224 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5225 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5226 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5227 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5228 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5229 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5230 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5231 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5232 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5233 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5234
5235 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5236 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5237 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5238 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5239 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5240 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5241 are often the only way to detect them.
5242
5243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5245
5246 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5247
5248
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005249option http-keep-alive
5250no option http-keep-alive
5251 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5253 yes | yes | yes | yes
5254 Arguments : none
5255
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005256 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5257 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5258 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5259 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5260 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5261 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5262 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5263
5264 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5265 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005266 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5267 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5268 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5269 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5270 situations where this option may be useful :
5271
5272 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5273 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5274
5275 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5276 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5277
5278 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5279 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5280 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5281 request.
5282
5283 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5284 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005285 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5286 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5287 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005288
5289 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5290 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5291
5292 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5293 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5294 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5295 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5296 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5297 not set.
5298
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005299 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5300 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005301 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005302 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005303
5304 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005305 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5306 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005307
5308
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005309option http-no-delay
5310no option http-no-delay
5311 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5313 yes | yes | yes | yes
5314 Arguments : none
5315
5316 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5317 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5318 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5319 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5320 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5321 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5322 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5323 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5324 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5325 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5326 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5327 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5328 affected.
5329
5330 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5331 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5332 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5333 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5334 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5335 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5336 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5337 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5338 latency environments.
5339
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005340 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5341
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005342
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005343option http-pretend-keepalive
5344no option http-pretend-keepalive
5345 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5347 yes | yes | yes | yes
5348 Arguments : none
5349
5350 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5351 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5352 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5353 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5354 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5355 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5356 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5357 consider the response complete.
5358
5359 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5360 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5361 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5362 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5363 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5364 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5365
5366 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5367 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5368 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5369 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5370 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5371 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5372 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5373
5374 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5375 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005376 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005377 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5378 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005379
5380 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5381 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5382
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005383 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5384 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005385
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005386
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005387option http-server-close
5388no option http-server-close
5389 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | yes | yes | yes
5392 Arguments : none
5393
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005394 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5395 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5396 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5397 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5398 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5399 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5400 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5401 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5402 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5403 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5404 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5405 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5406 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5407 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5408 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5409 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005410
5411 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5412 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5413 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5414 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005415 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5416 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005417
5418 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5419 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005420 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5421 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005422 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5423 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005424
5425 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5426 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5427
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005428 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005429 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5430 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005431
5432
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005433option http-tunnel
5434no option http-tunnel
5435 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 yes | yes | yes | yes
5438 Arguments : none
5439
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005440 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5441 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5442 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5443 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5444 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5445 "option http-tunnel".
5446
5447 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005448 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005449 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5450 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5451 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5452 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5453 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5454 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5455 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005456
5457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5459
5460 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5461 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5462 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5463
5464
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005465option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005466no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005467 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5469 yes | yes | yes | no
5470 Arguments : none
5471
5472 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5473 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5474 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5475 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5476 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5477 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5478 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5479
5480 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5481 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005482 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5483 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5484 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005485
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005486 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5487 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5488 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5489 front of an existing proxy.
5490
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005491 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5492
5493 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5494 http-server-close".
5495
5496
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005497option httpchk
5498option httpchk <uri>
5499option httpchk <method> <uri>
5500option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5501 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5503 yes | no | yes | yes
5504 Arguments :
5505 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5506 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5507 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5508 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5509 ones.
5510
5511 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5512 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5513 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5514
5515 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5516 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5517 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5518 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5519 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5520
5521 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5522 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5523 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5524 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5525 the lack of any response.
5526
5527 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5528
5529 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5530 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5531 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5532
5533 Examples :
5534 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5535 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5536 backend https_relay
5537 mode tcp
5538 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5539 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5540
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005541 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5542 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5543 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005544
5545
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005546option httpclose
5547no option httpclose
5548 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5550 yes | yes | yes | yes
5551 Arguments : none
5552
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005553 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5554 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5555 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5556 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005557 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005558 "option http-tunnel".
5559
5560 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5561 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5562 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5563 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5564 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5565 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5566 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5567 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005568
5569 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005570 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005571 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5572 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5573 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5574 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5575 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005576
5577 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5578 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005579 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5580 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005581 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5582 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005583
5584 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5585 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5586
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005587 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5588 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005589
5590
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005591option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005592 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5594 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005595 Arguments :
5596 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5597 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5598 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5599 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5600 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005601
5602 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5603 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5604 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5605 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5606 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5607 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5608 ports.
5609
5610 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5611
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005612 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5613 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005615 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005616
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005617
5618option http_proxy
5619no option http_proxy
5620 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 yes | yes | yes | yes
5623 Arguments : none
5624
5625 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5626 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5627 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5628 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5629 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5630
5631 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5632 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005633 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5634 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005635
5636 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5637 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5638
5639 Example :
5640 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5641 backend direct_forward
5642 option httpclose
5643 option http_proxy
5644
5645 See also : "option httpclose"
5646
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005647
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005648option independent-streams
5649no option independent-streams
5650 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5652 yes | yes | yes | yes
5653 Arguments : none
5654
5655 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5656 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5657 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5658 receive data or not.
5659
5660 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5661 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5662 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5663 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5664 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5665 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5666 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5667 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5668 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5669 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5670 socket buffers.
5671
5672 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5673 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5674 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5675 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5676 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5677
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005678 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005679 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5680 deprecated.
5681
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005682 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005683
5684
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005685option ldap-check
5686 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5688 yes | no | yes | yes
5689 Arguments : none
5690
5691 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5692 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5693 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5694 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5695
5696 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5697 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5698
5699 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5700 configure it.
5701
5702 Example :
5703 option ldap-check
5704
5705 See also : "option httpchk"
5706
5707
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005708option external-check
5709 Use external processes for server health checks
5710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5711 yes | no | yes | yes
5712
5713 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5714 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5715 command".
5716
5717 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5718
5719 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5720
5721
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005722option log-health-checks
5723no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005724 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5726 yes | no | yes | yes
5727 Arguments : none
5728
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005729 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5730 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5731 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005732
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005733 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5734 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5735 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5736 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5737 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5738
5739 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5740 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005741
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005742 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5743 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5744 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005745
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005746
5747option log-separate-errors
5748no option log-separate-errors
5749 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 yes | yes | yes | no
5752 Arguments : none
5753
5754 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5755 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5756 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5757 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5758 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5759 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5760 provides very important information.
5761
5762 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5763 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5764 error logs.
5765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005766 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005767 logging.
5768
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005769
5770option logasap
5771no option logasap
5772 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 yes | yes | yes | no
5775 Arguments : none
5776
5777 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5778 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5779 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5780 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5781 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5782 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5783 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005784 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005785 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5786 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5787
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005788 Examples :
5789 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5790 mode http
5791 option httplog
5792 option logasap
5793 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5794
5795 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5796 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5797 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5798 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005800 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005801 logging.
5802
5803
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005804option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005805 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5807 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005808 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005809 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5810 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005811 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005812
5813 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5814 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5815 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5816 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5817 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5818 in the MySQL table, like this :
5819
5820 USE mysql;
5821 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5822 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5823
5824 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5825 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5826 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5827 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5828 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5829 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5830 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5831 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5832 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5833
5834 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5835 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005836
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005837 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005838
5839 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5840 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5841 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5842 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005843 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5844 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005845
5846 See also: "option httpchk"
5847
5848
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005849option nolinger
5850no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005851 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5853 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005854 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005855
5856 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5857 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5858 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5859 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5860 connections.
5861
5862 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5863 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5864 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5865 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5866 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5867 this too.
5868
5869 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5870 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5871 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5872
5873 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5874 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5875 for servers.
5876
5877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5879
5880
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005881option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5882 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 yes | yes | yes | yes
5885 Arguments :
5886 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5887 matching <network>
5888 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5889 header name.
5890
5891 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5892 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5893 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5894 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5895 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5896 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5897 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5898 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5899 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5900 possible that the client has already brought one.
5901
5902 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5903 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5904 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5905 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5906 header and requires different one.
5907
5908 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5909 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5910 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5911 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5912 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5913 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5914 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5915
5916 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5917 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5918 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5919 both are defined.
5920
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005921 Examples :
5922 # Original Destination address
5923 frontend www
5924 mode http
5925 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5926
5927 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5928 backend www
5929 mode http
5930 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5931
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005932 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5933 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005934
5935
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005936option persist
5937no option persist
5938 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5940 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005941 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005942
5943 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5944 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5945 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5946 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5947 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5948 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5949 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5950 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5951 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5952 redirected to another valid server.
5953
5954 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5955 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5956
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005957 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005958
5959
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005960option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5961 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5963 yes | no | yes | yes
5964 Arguments :
5965 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5966 PostgreSQL server.
5967
5968 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5969 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5970 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5971 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5972
5973 See also: "option httpchk"
5974
5975
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005976option prefer-last-server
5977no option prefer-last-server
5978 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5980 yes | no | yes | yes
5981 Arguments : none
5982
5983 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5984 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5985 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5986 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5987 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5988 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5989 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5990 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5991 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005992 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5993 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5994 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5995 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5996 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5997 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5998 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005999
6000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6002
6003 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6004
6005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006006option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006007option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006008no option redispatch
6009 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6011 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006012 Arguments :
6013 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6014 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6015 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6016 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6017 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6018 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6019 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6020 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6021 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006023
6024 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6025 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6026 be able to access the service anymore.
6027
6028 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6029 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6030
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006031 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006032 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6033 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006035 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6036 "redisp" keywords.
6037
6038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6040
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006041 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006042
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006043
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006044option redis-check
6045 Use redis health checks for server testing
6046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6047 yes | no | yes | yes
6048 Arguments : none
6049
6050 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6051 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6052 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6053 find the "+PONG" response message.
6054
6055 Example :
6056 option redis-check
6057
6058 See also : "option httpchk"
6059
6060
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006061option smtpchk
6062option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6063 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6065 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006066 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006067 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6068 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6069 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6070
6071 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6072 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6073 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6074
6075 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6076 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6077 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6078 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6079 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6080 dead server.
6081
6082 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6083 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6084 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6085 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6086
6087 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6088 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6089 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6090 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006091 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006092
6093 Example :
6094 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6095
6096 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006099option socket-stats
6100no option socket-stats
6101
6102 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6104 yes | yes | yes | no
6105
6106 Arguments : none
6107
6108
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006109option splice-auto
6110no option splice-auto
6111 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6113 yes | yes | yes | yes
6114 Arguments : none
6115
6116 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6117 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6118 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6119 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006120 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006121 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6122 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6123 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6124 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6125
6126 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6127 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6128 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6129 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6130 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6131 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6132 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6133 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6134 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6135 keyword.
6136
6137 Example :
6138 option splice-auto
6139
6140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6142
6143 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6144 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6145
6146
6147option splice-request
6148no option splice-request
6149 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6151 yes | yes | yes | yes
6152 Arguments : none
6153
6154 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006155 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006156 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6157 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6158 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6159 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6160
6161 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6162
6163 Example :
6164 option splice-request
6165
6166 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6167 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6168
6169 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6170 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6171
6172
6173option splice-response
6174no option splice-response
6175 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6177 yes | yes | yes | yes
6178 Arguments : none
6179
6180 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006181 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006182 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6183 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6184 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6185 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6186
6187 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6188
6189 Example :
6190 option splice-response
6191
6192 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6193 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6194
6195 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6196 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6197
6198
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006199option srvtcpka
6200no option srvtcpka
6201 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6203 yes | no | yes | yes
6204 Arguments : none
6205
6206 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6207 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6208 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6209 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6210
6211 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6212 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6213 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6214 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6215
6216 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6217 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6218 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6219 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6220 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6221
6222 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6223
6224 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6225 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6226 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6227
6228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6230
6231 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6232
6233
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006234option ssl-hello-chk
6235 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6237 yes | no | yes | yes
6238 Arguments : none
6239
6240 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6241 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6242 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6243 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6244 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6245 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6246 hello message.
6247
6248 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6249 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6250 messages, which is appreciable.
6251
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006252 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6253 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6254 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006255
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006256 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6257
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006258
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006259option tcp-check
6260 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6261 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6262 yes | no | yes | yes
6263
6264 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6265 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6266
6267 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6268 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6269 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6270
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006271 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006272 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6273 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6274 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6275 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6276 only.
6277
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006278 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006279 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6280 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6281 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6282 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6283
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006284 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006285 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6286 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006287 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006288 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6289 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6290 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6291 the respective protocols.
6292 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6293 analysed.
6294
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006295 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6296 script.
6297
6298 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6299 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6300 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6301 The "comment" is of course optional.
6302
6303
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006304 Examples :
6305 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6306 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006307 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006308
6309 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6310 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006311 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006312
6313 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6314 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006315 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006316 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006317 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006318 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006319 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006320 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006321 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6322 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006323 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006324 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6325 tcp-check expect string +OK
6326
6327 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6328 (send many headers before analyzing)
6329 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006330 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006331 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6332 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6333 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6334 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006335 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006336
6337
6338 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6339
6340
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006341option tcp-smart-accept
6342no option tcp-smart-accept
6343 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6345 yes | yes | yes | no
6346 Arguments : none
6347
6348 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6349 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6350 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6351 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6352 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6353 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6354
6355 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6356 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6357 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6358 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6359
6360 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6361 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6362 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6363 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6364
6365 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6366 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6367 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6368
6369 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6370 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6371 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6372
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006373 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6374
6375
6376option tcp-smart-connect
6377no option tcp-smart-connect
6378 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6380 yes | no | yes | yes
6381 Arguments : none
6382
6383 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6384 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6385 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6386 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6387 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6388
6389 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6390 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6391 complex.
6392
6393 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6394 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6395 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6396
6397 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6398 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6399
6400 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6401
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006402
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006403option tcpka
6404 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6406 yes | yes | yes | yes
6407 Arguments : none
6408
6409 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6410 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6411 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6412 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6413
6414 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6415 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6416 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6417 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6418
6419 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6420 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6421 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6422 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6423 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6424
6425 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6426
6427 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6428 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6429 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6430 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6431 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6432 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6433 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6434 backends.
6435
6436 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6437
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006438
6439option tcplog
6440 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6442 yes | yes | yes | yes
6443 Arguments : none
6444
6445 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6446 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6447 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6448 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6449 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6450 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6451 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6452 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6453
6454 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006456 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006457
6458
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006459option transparent
6460no option transparent
6461 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006463 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006464 Arguments : none
6465
6466 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6467 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6468 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6469 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6470 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6471 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6472 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6473 appropriate server.
6474
6475 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6476 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6477
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006478 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006479 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006480
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006481
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006482external-check command <command>
6483 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6485 yes | no | yes | yes
6486
6487 Arguments :
6488 <command> is the external command to run
6489
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006490 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6491
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006492 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006493
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006494 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6495 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6496 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6497 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6498 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6499 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006500
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006501 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6502
6503 Environment variables :
6504 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6505 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6506
6507 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6508
6509 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6510
6511 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6512 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6513 for a UNIX socket).
6514
6515 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6516
6517 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6518
6519 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6520
6521 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6522
6523 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6524
6525 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6526 socket).
6527
6528 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6529 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6530
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006531 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6532 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6533 failed.
6534
6535 Example :
6536 external-check command /bin/true
6537
6538 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6539
6540
6541external-check path <path>
6542 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6544 yes | no | yes | yes
6545
6546 Arguments :
6547 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6548
6549 The default path is "".
6550
6551 Example :
6552 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6553
6554 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6555 "external-check command"
6556
6557
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006558persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006559persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006560 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6562 yes | no | yes | yes
6563 Arguments :
6564 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006565 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6566 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006567
6568 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6569 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6570 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6571 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6572 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6573 forwarded to this server.
6574
6575 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6576 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6577 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006578 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006579 a single "listen" section.
6580
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006581 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6582 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6583 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6584
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006585 Example :
6586 listen tse-farm
6587 bind :3389
6588 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6589 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6590 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6591 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6592 persist rdp-cookie
6593 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006594 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006595 balance rdp-cookie
6596 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6597 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6598
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006599 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6600 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006601
6602
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006603rate-limit sessions <rate>
6604 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6606 yes | yes | yes | no
6607 Arguments :
6608 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6609 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6610
6611 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6612 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6613 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6614 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6615 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6616 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6617
6618 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6619 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6620 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6621 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6622
6623 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6624 listen smtp
6625 mode tcp
6626 bind :25
6627 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006628 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006629
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006630 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6631 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6632 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006633
6634 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6635
6636
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006637redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6638redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6639redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006640 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6642 no | yes | yes | yes
6643
6644 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006645 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006646
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006647 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006648 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006649 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6650 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6651 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006652
6653 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6654 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6655 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6656 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6657 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006658 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6659 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6660 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6661 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006662
6663 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6664 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6665 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6666 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6667 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6668 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006669 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006670 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006671 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6672 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6673 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006674
6675 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006676 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6677 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6678 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006679 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006680 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6681 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6682 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6683 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006684
6685 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6686 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6687
6688 - "drop-query"
6689 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6690 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6691 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6692 with a location-type redirect.
6693
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006694 - "append-slash"
6695 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6696 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6697 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6698 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6699
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006700 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6701 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6702 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6703 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6704 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6705 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6706 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6707
6708 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6709 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6710 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6711 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6712 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6713 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6714 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006715
6716 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6717 acl clear dst_port 80
6718 acl secure dst_port 8080
6719 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006720 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006721 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006722 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6723
6724 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006725 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6726 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6727 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006728 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006729
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006730 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6731 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6732 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6733
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006734 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006735 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006736
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006737 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006738 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6739 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6740 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006742 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006743
6744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006745redisp (deprecated)
6746redispatch (deprecated)
6747 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6748 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6749 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006750 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006751
6752 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6753 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6754 be able to access the service anymore.
6755
6756 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6757 redistribute them to a working server.
6758
6759 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6760 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6761 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006763 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6764 "option redispatch" instead.
6765
6766 See also : "option redispatch"
6767
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006768
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006769reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006770 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6772 no | yes | yes | yes
6773 Arguments :
6774 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6775 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006776 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006777
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006778 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6779 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6780
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006781 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6782 the last header of an HTTP request.
6783
6784 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6785 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6786 responses.
6787
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006788 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6789 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6790 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6791
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006792 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6793 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006794
6795
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006796reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6797reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006798 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6800 no | yes | yes | yes
6801 Arguments :
6802 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6803 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6804 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6805 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6806 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6807 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6808 ignores case.
6809
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006810 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6811 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6812
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006813 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6814 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6815 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6816 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006817 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006818
6819 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6820 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6821
6822 Example :
6823 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6824 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6825 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6826
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006827 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6828 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006829
6830
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006831reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6832reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006833 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6835 no | yes | yes | yes
6836 Arguments :
6837 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6838 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6839 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6840 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6841 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6842 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6843
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006844 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6845 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6846
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006847 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6848 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6849 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6850 next servers.
6851
6852 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6853 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6854 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6855
6856 Example :
6857 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6858 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6859 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6860
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006861 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6862 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006863
6864
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006865reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6866reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006867 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6869 no | yes | yes | yes
6870 Arguments :
6871 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6872 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6873 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6874 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6875 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6876 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6877 case.
6878
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006879 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6880 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6881
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006882 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6883 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6884 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6885 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006886 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006887
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006888 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006889 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006890 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006891
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006892 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6893 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6894
6895 Example :
6896 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6897 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6898 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6899
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006900 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6901 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006902
6903
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006904reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6905reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006906 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6908 no | yes | yes | yes
6909 Arguments :
6910 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6911 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6912 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6913 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6914 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6915 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6916 case.
6917
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006918 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6919 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6920
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006921 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6922 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6923 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6924 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6925
6926 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6927 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6928
6929 Example :
6930 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6931 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6932 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6933 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6934
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006935 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6936 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006937
6938
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006939reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6940reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006941 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6943 no | yes | yes | yes
6944 Arguments :
6945 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6946 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6947 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6948 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6949 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6950 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6951
6952 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6953 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6954 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6955 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006956 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006957
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006958 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6959 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6960
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006961 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6962 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6963 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6964
6965 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6966 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6967 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6968 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6969 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6970
6971 Example :
6972 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006973 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006974 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6975 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6976
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006977 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
6978 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006979
6980
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006981reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6982reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006983 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6985 no | yes | yes | yes
6986 Arguments :
6987 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6988 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6989 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6990 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6991 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6992 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6993 ignores case.
6994
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006995 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6996 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6997
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006998 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6999 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007000 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7001 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7002 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007003 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7004 not set.
7005
7006 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7007 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7008 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7009 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7010 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7011
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007012 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007013 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7014 # block all others.
7015 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7016 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7017
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007018 # block bad guys
7019 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7020 reqitarpit . if badguys
7021
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007022 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7023 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007024
7025
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007026retries <value>
7027 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7029 yes | no | yes | yes
7030 Arguments :
7031 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7032 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7033 default value is 3.
7034
7035 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7036 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7037 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7038
7039 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007040 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7041 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007042
7043 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7044 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7045
7046 See also : "option redispatch"
7047
7048
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007049rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007050 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7052 no | yes | yes | yes
7053 Arguments :
7054 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7055 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007056 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007057
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007058 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7059 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7060
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007061 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7062 the last header of an HTTP response.
7063
7064 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7065 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7066 responses.
7067
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007068 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7069 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007070
7071
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007072rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7073rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007074 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 no | yes | yes | yes
7077 Arguments :
7078 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7079 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7080 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7081 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7082 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7083 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7084 ignores case.
7085
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007086 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7087 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7088
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007089 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7090 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007091 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007092 client.
7093
7094 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7095 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7096 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7097
7098 Example :
7099 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007100 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007101
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007102 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7103 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007104
7105
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007106rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7107rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007108 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7110 no | yes | yes | yes
7111 Arguments :
7112 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7113 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7114 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7115 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7116 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7117 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7118 ignores case.
7119
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007120 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7121 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7122
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007123 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7124 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7125 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7126 case-sensitive.
7127
7128 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007129 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7130 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7131 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007132
7133 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7134 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7135
7136 Example :
7137 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7138 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7139
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007140 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7141 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007142
7143
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007144rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7145rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007146 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 no | yes | yes | yes
7149 Arguments :
7150 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7151 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7152 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7153 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7154 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7155 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7156 ignores case.
7157
7158 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7159 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7160 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7161 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007162 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007163
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007164 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7165 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7166
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007167 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7168 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7169 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7170
7171 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7172 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7173 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7174 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7175 are not case-sensitive.
7176
7177 Example :
7178 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7179 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7180
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007181 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7182 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007183
7184
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007185server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007186 Declare a server in a backend
7187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7188 no | no | yes | yes
7189 Arguments :
7190 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007191 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007192 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007193
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007194 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7195 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7196 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7197 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007198 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7199 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7200 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7201 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7202 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007203 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7204 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7205 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7206 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7207 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7208 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7209 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007210 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007211 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7212 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7213 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007214
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007215 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007216 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7217 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7218 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7219 adding this value to the client's port.
7220
7221 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7222 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007223 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007224
7225 Examples :
7226 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7227 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007228 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007229 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7230 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7231 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007232
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007233 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7234 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7235 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7236 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7237 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7238
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007239 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7240 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007241
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007242server-state-file-name [<file>]
7243 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7244 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7245 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7246 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7247 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7248 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7249
7250 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7251 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7252
7253 global
7254 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7255
7256 backend bk
7257 load-server-state-from-file
7258
7259 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7260 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007261
7262source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007263source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007264source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007265 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7267 yes | no | yes | yes
7268 Arguments :
7269 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7270 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007271
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007272 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007273 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7274 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7275 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7276 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7277 supported prefixes are :
7278 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7279 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7280 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007281 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007282 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7283 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007284
7285 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7286 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007287 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7288 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7289 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007290
7291 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7292 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7293 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7294 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7295 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7296 <addr>.
7297
7298 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7299 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7300 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7301 port.
7302
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007303 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7304 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7305 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7306 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007307 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007308 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7309 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7310 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7311 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7312 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7313 HTTP header.
7314
7315 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7316 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007317 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007318 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7319 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7320 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7321 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7322 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7323 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7324 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7325
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007326 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7327 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7328 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7329 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7330 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7331 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7332
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007333 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7334 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7335 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7336 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7337
7338 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7339 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7340 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7341 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7342 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7343 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7344
7345 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7346 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7347 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7348 there are two methods :
7349
7350 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7351 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7352 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7353 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7354 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7355 of the client ranges may be used.
7356
7357 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7358 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7359 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7360 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7361 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7362 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7363 same session.
7364
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007365 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7366 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7367 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007368 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007369
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007370 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7371
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007372 Examples :
7373 backend private
7374 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7375 source 192.168.1.200
7376
7377 backend transparent_ssl1
7378 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7379 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7380
7381 backend transparent_ssl2
7382 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7383 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7384 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7385
7386 backend transparent_ssl3
7387 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7388 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7389 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7390
7391 backend transparent_smtp
7392 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7393 # with Tproxy version 4.
7394 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7395
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007396 backend transparent_http
7397 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7398 # proxy.
7399 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007401 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007402 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007404
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007405srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7406 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7408 yes | no | yes | yes
7409 Arguments :
7410 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7411 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7412 as explained at the top of this document.
7413
7414 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7415 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7416 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7417 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7418 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7419 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7420 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7421
7422 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7423 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7424 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7425 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7426 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007427 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007428 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007429 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007430
7431 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7432 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7433 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7434 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7435 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7436 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7437
7438 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7439 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7440
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007441 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7442 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007443
7444
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007445stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7446 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007448 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007449
7450 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7451 matched.
7452
7453 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7454 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7455
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007456 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7457 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7458 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7459
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007460 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7461 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7462 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7463 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007464
7465 Example :
7466 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7467 backend stats_localhost
7468 stats enable
7469 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7470
7471 Example :
7472 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7473 backend stats_auth
7474 stats enable
7475 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7476 stats admin if TRUE
7477
7478 Example :
7479 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7480 userlist stats-auth
7481 group admin users admin
7482 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7483 group readonly users haproxy
7484 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7485
7486 backend stats_auth
7487 stats enable
7488 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7489 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7490 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7491 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7492
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007493 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7494 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7495 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007496
7497
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007498stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7499 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007501 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007502 Arguments :
7503 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7504
7505 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7506
7507 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7508 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7509 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7510 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7511 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7512 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7513
7514 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7515 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7516 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007517 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007518
7519 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7520 report using "stats scope".
7521
7522 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7523 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7524 unobvious parameters.
7525
7526 Example :
7527 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7528 backend public_www
7529 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7530 stats enable
7531 stats hide-version
7532 stats scope .
7533 stats uri /admin?stats
7534 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7535 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7536 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7537
7538 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7539 backend private_monitoring
7540 stats enable
7541 stats uri /admin?stats
7542 stats refresh 5s
7543
7544 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7545
7546
7547stats enable
7548 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007550 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007551 Arguments : none
7552
7553 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7554 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7555 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7556 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7557 - stats auth : no authentication
7558 - stats scope : no restriction
7559
7560 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7561 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7562 unobvious parameters.
7563
7564 Example :
7565 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7566 backend public_www
7567 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7568 stats enable
7569 stats hide-version
7570 stats scope .
7571 stats uri /admin?stats
7572 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7573 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7574 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7575
7576 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7577 backend private_monitoring
7578 stats enable
7579 stats uri /admin?stats
7580 stats refresh 5s
7581
7582 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7583
7584
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007585stats hide-version
7586 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007588 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007589 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007590
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007591 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7592 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7593 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7594 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7595 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7596 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007598 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7599 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7600 unobvious parameters.
7601
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007602 Example :
7603 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7604 backend public_www
7605 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007606 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007607 stats hide-version
7608 stats scope .
7609 stats uri /admin?stats
7610 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7611 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7612 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007613
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007614 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7615 backend private_monitoring
7616 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007617 stats uri /admin?stats
7618 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007619
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007620 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007621
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007622
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007623stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7624 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7625 Access control for statistics
7626
7627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7628 no | no | yes | yes
7629
7630 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7631 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7632 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7633 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7634 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7635 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7636
7637 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7638 instance.
7639
7640 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7641 about ACL usage.
7642
7643
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007644stats realm <realm>
7645 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007647 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007648 Arguments :
7649 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7650 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7651 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7652
7653 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7654 using a backslash ('\').
7655
7656 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7657 only related to authentication.
7658
7659 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7660 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7661 unobvious parameters.
7662
7663 Example :
7664 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7665 backend public_www
7666 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7667 stats enable
7668 stats hide-version
7669 stats scope .
7670 stats uri /admin?stats
7671 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7672 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7673 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7674
7675 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7676 backend private_monitoring
7677 stats enable
7678 stats uri /admin?stats
7679 stats refresh 5s
7680
7681 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7682
7683
7684stats refresh <delay>
7685 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007687 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007688 Arguments :
7689 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7690 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7691 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7692 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7693 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7694 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7695
7696 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7697 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7698 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7699 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7700
7701 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7702 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7703 unobvious parameters.
7704
7705 Example :
7706 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7707 backend public_www
7708 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7709 stats enable
7710 stats hide-version
7711 stats scope .
7712 stats uri /admin?stats
7713 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7714 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7715 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7716
7717 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7718 backend private_monitoring
7719 stats enable
7720 stats uri /admin?stats
7721 stats refresh 5s
7722
7723 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7724
7725
7726stats scope { <name> | "." }
7727 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007729 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007730 Arguments :
7731 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7732 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7733 section in which the statement appears.
7734
7735 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7736 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7737 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7738 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7739 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7740 exists.
7741
7742 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7743 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7744 unobvious parameters.
7745
7746 Example :
7747 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7748 backend public_www
7749 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7750 stats enable
7751 stats hide-version
7752 stats scope .
7753 stats uri /admin?stats
7754 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7755 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7756 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7757
7758 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7759 backend private_monitoring
7760 stats enable
7761 stats uri /admin?stats
7762 stats refresh 5s
7763
7764 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7765
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007766
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007767stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007768 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007770 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007771
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007772 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007773 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7774
7775 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7776 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7777
7778 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7779 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007780 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007781
7782 Example :
7783 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7784 backend private_monitoring
7785 stats enable
7786 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7787 stats uri /admin?stats
7788 stats refresh 5s
7789
7790 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7791 global section.
7792
7793
7794stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007795 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7797 yes | yes | yes | yes
7798 Arguments : none
7799
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007800 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007801 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7802 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7803 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7804 - IP (socket, server)
7805 - cookie (backend, server)
7806
7807 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7808 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007809 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007810
7811 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7812
7813
7814stats show-node [ <name> ]
7815 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007818 Arguments:
7819 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7820 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7821
7822 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7823 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007824 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007825
7826 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7827 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7828 unobvious parameters.
7829
7830 Example:
7831 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7832 backend private_monitoring
7833 stats enable
7834 stats show-node Europe-1
7835 stats uri /admin?stats
7836 stats refresh 5s
7837
7838 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7839 section.
7840
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007841
7842stats uri <prefix>
7843 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007845 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007846 Arguments :
7847 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7848 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7849 query string.
7850
7851 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7852 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7853 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7854 possible to reach it in the application.
7855
7856 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007857 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007858 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7859 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7860 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7861 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7862
7863 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7864 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7865 an address or a port to statistics only.
7866
7867 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7868 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7869 unobvious parameters.
7870
7871 Example :
7872 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7873 backend public_www
7874 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7875 stats enable
7876 stats hide-version
7877 stats scope .
7878 stats uri /admin?stats
7879 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7880 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7881 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7882
7883 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7884 backend private_monitoring
7885 stats enable
7886 stats uri /admin?stats
7887 stats refresh 5s
7888
7889 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7890
7891
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007892stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7893 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007895 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007896
7897 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007898 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007899 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7900 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7901 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7902
7903 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7904 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7905 the "stick-table" statement.
7906
7907 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7908 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7909 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7910 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7911 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7912
7913 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7914 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7915 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7916 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7917 transformation rules.
7918
7919 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7920 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7921 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7922 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7923 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7924 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7925 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7926
7927 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7928 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7929 ACL based conditions.
7930
7931 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7932 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7933 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7934 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7935
7936 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7937 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7938 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7939 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7940
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007941 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7942 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7943 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7944
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007945 Example :
7946 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7947 # last 30 minutes
7948 backend pop
7949 mode tcp
7950 balance roundrobin
7951 stick store-request src
7952 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7953 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7954 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7955
7956 backend smtp
7957 mode tcp
7958 balance roundrobin
7959 stick match src table pop
7960 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7961 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7962
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007963 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007964 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007965
7966
7967stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7968 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7970 no | no | yes | yes
7971
7972 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7973 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7974 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7975 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7976
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007977 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7978 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7979 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7980
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007981 Examples :
7982 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007983 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007984
7985 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7986 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7987 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7988
7989
7990 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7991 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7992 backend http
7993 mode http
7994 balance roundrobin
7995 stick on src table https
7996 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7997 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7998 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7999
8000 backend https
8001 mode tcp
8002 balance roundrobin
8003 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8004 stick on src
8005 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8006 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8007
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008008 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008009
8010
8011stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8012 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8014 no | no | yes | yes
8015
8016 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008017 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008018 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8019 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8020 server is selected.
8021
8022 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8023 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8024 the "stick-table" statement.
8025
8026 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8027 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8028 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8029 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8030 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8031 address.
8032
8033 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8034 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8035 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8036 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8037 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8038 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8039 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8040 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8041 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8042 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8043
8044 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8045 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8046 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8047 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8048 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8049 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8050 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8051
8052 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8053 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8054 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8055 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8056
8057 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8058 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8059 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8060 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8061 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8062 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008063 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8064 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8065 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8066 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8067 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8068 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008069
8070 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8071 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8072 the request.
8073
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008074 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8075 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8076 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8077
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008078 Example :
8079 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8080 # last 30 minutes
8081 backend pop
8082 mode tcp
8083 balance roundrobin
8084 stick store-request src
8085 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8086 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8087 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8088
8089 backend smtp
8090 mode tcp
8091 balance roundrobin
8092 stick match src table pop
8093 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8094 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8095
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008096 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008097 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008098
8099
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008100stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008101 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8102 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008103 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008105 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008106
8107 Arguments :
8108 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8109 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8110 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8111 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8112
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008113 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8114 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8115 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8116 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8117
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008118 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8119 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8120 instance.
8121
8122 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8123 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8124 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8125 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8126 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8127 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008128 to 32 characters.
8129
8130 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8131 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8132 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008133 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008134 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8135 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008136
8137 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008138 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8139 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008140 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8141 increase.
8142
8143 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008144 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8145 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8146 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008147
8148 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8149 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8150 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8151 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8152 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8153 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8154 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8155 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8156 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8157 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8158 parameter (see below).
8159
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008160 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8161 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8162 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8163 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8164 soft restart.
8165
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008166 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8167 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008168
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008169 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8170 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8171 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8172 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8173 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008174 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008175 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8176 if not expiration delay is specified.
8177
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008178 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8179 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8180 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8181 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008182 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8183 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8184 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8185 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8186 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8187 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8188 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8189 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8190 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8191 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8192 types and their arguments.
8193
8194 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8195 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8196 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8197 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8198
8199 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8200 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8201 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8202 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8203
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008204 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8205 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8206 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8207 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8208 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8209 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8210
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008211 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8212 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8213 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8214 they were received.
8215
8216 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8217 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8218 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8219 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8220 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8221
8222 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8223 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8224 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8225 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8226 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8227
8228 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8229 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8230 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8231
8232 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8233 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8234 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8235 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8236 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8237
8238 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8239 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8240 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8241 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8242 the client side.
8243
8244 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8245 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8246 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8247 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8248 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8249 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8250 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8251
8252 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8253 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8254 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8255 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8256 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8257 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8258 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8259
8260 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8261 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8262 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8263 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8264 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8265 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8266
8267 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8268 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8269 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8270 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8271
8272 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8273 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8274 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8275 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8276 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8277 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8278 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8279 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8280 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8281 recommended for better fairness.
8282
8283 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8284 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8285 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8286 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8287
8288 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8289 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8290 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8291 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8292 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8293 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8294 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8295 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8296 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8297 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008298
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008299 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8300 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008301 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8302 reference it.
8303
8304 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8305 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008306 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8307 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8308 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008309
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008310 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8311 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8312 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8313 something that can be ignored.
8314
8315 Example:
8316 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8317 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8318 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8319 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8320
8321 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008322 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008323
8324
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008325stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008326 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8328 no | no | yes | yes
8329
8330 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008331 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008332 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8333 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8334 server is selected.
8335
8336 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8337 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8338 the "stick-table" statement.
8339
8340 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8341 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8342 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8343 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8344
8345 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8346 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8347 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8348 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8349 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8350 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008351 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008352 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8353 rules.
8354
8355 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8356 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8357 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8358 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8359 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8360 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8361 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8362
8363 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8364 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8365 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8366 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8367
8368 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8369 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8370 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8371 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8372 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8373 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008374 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8375 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8376 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8377 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8378 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8379 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8380 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8381 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8382 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008383
8384 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8385
8386 Example :
8387 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8388 backend https
8389 mode tcp
8390 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008391 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008392 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008393
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008394 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8395 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8396
8397 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8398 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8399 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8400
8401 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8402 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008403
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008404 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8405 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8406 # at offset 44.
8407
8408 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8409 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8410
8411 # Learn on response if server hello.
8412 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008413
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008414 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8415 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8416
8417 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8418 extraction.
8419
8420
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008421tcp-check connect [params*]
8422 Opens a new connection
8423 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8424 no | no | yes | yes
8425
8426 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8427 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8428 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8429
8430 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8431 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8432 of the sequence.
8433
8434 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8435 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8436 do.
8437
8438 Parameters :
8439 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8440 use the TCP connection.
8441
8442 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8443 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8444 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8445
8446 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8447
8448 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8449
8450 Examples:
8451 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8452 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8453 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8454 option tcp-check
8455 tcp-check connect
8456 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8457 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8458 tcp-check send \r\n
8459 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8460 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8461 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8462 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8463 tcp-check send \r\n
8464 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8465 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8466
8467 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8468 option tcp-check
8469 tcp-check connect port 110
8470 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8471 tcp-check connect port 143
8472 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8473 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8474
8475 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8476
8477
8478tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8479 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8481 no | no | yes | yes
8482
8483 Arguments :
8484 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8485 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8486 binary.
8487 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8488 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8489 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8490
8491 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8492 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8493 with the usual backslash ('\').
8494 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8495 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8496 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8497 used upper or lower case.
8498
8499
8500 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8501
8502 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8503 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8504 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8505 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8506 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8507 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8508 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8509 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8510
8511 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8512 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8513 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8514 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8515 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8516 expression.
8517
8518 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8519 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8520 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8521 this exact hexadecimal string.
8522 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8523
8524 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8525 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8526 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8527 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8528 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8529 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8530 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8531 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8532 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8533 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8534 the null character.
8535
8536 Examples :
8537 # perform a POP check
8538 option tcp-check
8539 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8540
8541 # perform an IMAP check
8542 option tcp-check
8543 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8544
8545 # look for the redis master server
8546 option tcp-check
8547 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008548 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008549 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8550 tcp-check expect string role:master
8551 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8552 tcp-check expect string +OK
8553
8554
8555 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8556 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8557
8558
8559tcp-check send <data>
8560 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8562 no | no | yes | yes
8563
8564 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8565 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8566
8567 Examples :
8568 # look for the redis master server
8569 option tcp-check
8570 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8571 tcp-check expect string role:master
8572
8573 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8574 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8575
8576
8577tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8578 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8579 tcp health check
8580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8581 no | no | yes | yes
8582
8583 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8584 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8585 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8586 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8587 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8588 hexadecimal string.
8589 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8590
8591 Examples :
8592 # redis check in binary
8593 option tcp-check
8594 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8595 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8596
8597
8598 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8599 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8600
8601
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008602tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8603 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8605 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008606 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008607 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8608 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008609
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008610 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008611
8612 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8613 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008614 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8615 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8616 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8617 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8618 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8619 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008620
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008621 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8622 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8623 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8624 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008625
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008626 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008627 - accept :
8628 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8629 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8630 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008631
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008632 - reject :
8633 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8634 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8635 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8636 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8637 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8638 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8639 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8640 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8641 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8642 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8643 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8644 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008645
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008646 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8647 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8648 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8649 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8650 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8651 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8652 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8653 hosts.
8654
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008655 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8656 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8657 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8658 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8659 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8660 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8661 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8662 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8663
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008664 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8665 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8666 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8667 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8668 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8669 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8670 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8671 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8672 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008673 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8674 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008675
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008676 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008677 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008678 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008679 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008680 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8681 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008682 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008683 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8684 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8685 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8686 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8687 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008688
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008689 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008690 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008691 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008692 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8693 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8694 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8695 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008696
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008697 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8698 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8699 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8700 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008701
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008702 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8703 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8704 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8705 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8706 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008707 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8708 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8709 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8710 layer7 information is extracted.
8711
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008712 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8713 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8714 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8715 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8716 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008717
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008718 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8719 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8720 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8721 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8722
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008723 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8724 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8725 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8726 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8727 continues.
8728
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008729 - set-src <expr> :
8730 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8731 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8732 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8733 set-src"
8734
8735 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8736 followed by some converters.
8737
8738 Example:
8739
8740 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8741
8742 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
8743
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008744 - set-src-port <expr> :
8745 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8746 expression.
8747
8748 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8749 followed by some converters.
8750
8751 Example:
8752
8753 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8754
8755 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
8756 the source port to 0.
8757
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008758 - set-dst <expr> :
8759 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8760 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8761 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8762 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8763 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8764
8765 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8766 followed by some converters.
8767
8768 Example:
8769
8770 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8771 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8772
8773 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8774 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8775 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8776 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8777
8778
8779 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8780 followed by some converters.
8781
8782 Example:
8783
8784 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8785
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008786 - "silent-drop" :
8787 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8788 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8789 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8790 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8791 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8792 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8793 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8794 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8795 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8796 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8797 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8798 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8799 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8800 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8801 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8802 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8803
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008804 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8805 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8806 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008807
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008808 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8809 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8810 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008811
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008812 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008813 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008814 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008815
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008816 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8817 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8818 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008819
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008820 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008821 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8822 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008823
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008824 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8825
8826 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8827
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008828 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8829
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008830 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008831
8832
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008833tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8834 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008836 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008837 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008838 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8839 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008840
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008841 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008842
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008843 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8844 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8845 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8846 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8847 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008849 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8850 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8851 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8852 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008853 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8854 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8855 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8856 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8857 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8858 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008859 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008860 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008861
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008862 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8863 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8864 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8865 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008866
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008867 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008868 - accept : the request is accepted
8869 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8870 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008871 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008872 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008873 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008874 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008875 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008876
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008877 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8878 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008879
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008880 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8881 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8882 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8883 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8884 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8885 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008887 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008888 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8889 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008890
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008891 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008892 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8893 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8894 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8895 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008896 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8897 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8898 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008899
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008900 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008901 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8902 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8903 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008904
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008905 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8906 declared inline.
8907
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008908 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8909 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8910 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8911 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008912 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008913 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008914 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008915 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8916 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008918 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8919 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008920
8921 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8922 followed by some converters.
8923
8924 Example:
8925
8926 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8927
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008928 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008929 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8930 # and reject everything else.
8931 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8932 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008933 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008934 tcp-request content reject
8935
8936 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008937 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8938 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8939 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008940 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008941
8942 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8943 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8944 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008945 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008946 tcp-request content reject
8947
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008948 Example:
8949 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8950 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008951 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008952
8953 Example:
8954 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8955 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008956 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008957
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008958 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8959 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8960
8961 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008962 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008963 # protecting all our sites
8964 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008965 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8966 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008967 ...
8968 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8969
8970 backend http_dynamic
8971 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008972 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008973 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008974 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8975 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8976 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008977 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008979 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008980
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008981 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008982
8983
8984tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8985 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008987 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008988 Arguments :
8989 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8990 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8991 as explained at the top of this document.
8992
8993 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8994 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8995 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8996 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8997 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8998
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008999 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9000 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9001 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9002 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9003
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009004 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9005 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009006 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009007 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009008 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9009 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9010 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9011 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009012
9013 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9014 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9015 it pass through unaffected.
9016
9017 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9018 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9019 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009020 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009021 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9022 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009023 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9024 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9025 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009026
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009027 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009028 "timeout client".
9029
9030
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009031tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9032 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9034 no | no | yes | yes
9035 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009036 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9037 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009038
9039 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9040
9041 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9042 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9043 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009044 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9045 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009046
9047 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9048
9049 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9050 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9051 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9052 inserted.
9053
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009054 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009055 - accept :
9056 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9057 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9058 the rules evaluation.
9059
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009060 - close :
9061 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9062 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9063 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9064 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9065 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9066 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009067 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009068 protocols.
9069
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009070 - reject :
9071 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9072 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009073 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009074
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009075 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9076 Sets a variable.
9077
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009078 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9079 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9080 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9081 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9082
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009083 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9084 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9085 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9086 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9087 continues.
9088
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009089 - "silent-drop" :
9090 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9091 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9092 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9093 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9094 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9095 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9096 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9097 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9098 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9099 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9100 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9101 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9102 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9103 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9104 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9105 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9106
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009107 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9108 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9109 for changing the default action to a reject.
9110
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009111 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9112 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9113 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9114 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009115 period.
9116
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009117 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9118 declared inline.
9119
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009120 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9121 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9122 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9123 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009124 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009125 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009126 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009127 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9128 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009129 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009130 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9131 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009132
9133 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9134 followed by some converters.
9135
9136 Example:
9137
9138 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9139
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009140 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9141
9142 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9143
9144
9145tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9146 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9148 no | no | yes | yes
9149 Arguments :
9150 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9151 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9152 as explained at the top of this document.
9153
9154 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9155
9156
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009157timeout check <timeout>
9158 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9159 established.
9160
9161 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9162 yes | no | yes | yes
9163 Arguments:
9164 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9165 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9166 as explained at the top of this document.
9167
9168 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9169 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9170 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9171 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009172 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9173 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9174 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009175
9176 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9177 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9178
9179 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9180 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009181 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009182
9183 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9184 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9185 forget about it.
9186
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009187 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9188 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009189
9190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009191timeout client <timeout>
9192timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9193 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9195 yes | yes | yes | no
9196 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009197 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009198 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9199 as explained at the top of this document.
9200
9201 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9202 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9203 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009204 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9205 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9206 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9207 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009208 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9209 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9210 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009211 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009212 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009213 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9214 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009215 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9216 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009217
9218 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9219 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9220 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9221 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9222 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9223 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9224
9225 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9226 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9227 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9228
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009229 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9230 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009231
9232
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009233timeout client-fin <timeout>
9234 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9236 yes | yes | yes | no
9237 Arguments :
9238 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9239 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9240 as explained at the top of this document.
9241
9242 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9243 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9244 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9245 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9246 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9247 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9248 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9249 down in one direction.
9250
9251 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9252 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9253 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9254
9255 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9256
9257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009258timeout connect <timeout>
9259timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9260 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9262 yes | no | yes | yes
9263 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009264 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009265 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9266 as explained at the top of this document.
9267
9268 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009269 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009270 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009271 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009272 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9273 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009274
9275 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9276 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9277 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9278 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9279 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9280 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9281
9282 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9283 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9284 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9285
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009286 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9287 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009288
9289
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009290timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9291 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9293 yes | yes | yes | yes
9294 Arguments :
9295 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9296 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9297 as explained at the top of this document.
9298
9299 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9300 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9301 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9302 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9303 once the request has started to present itself.
9304
9305 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9306 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9307 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9308 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9309 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9310
9311 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9312 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9313 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9314 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9315
9316 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9317 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9318 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9319 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9320 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009321 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009322
9323 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9324 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9325 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9326 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9327
9328 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9329
9330
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009331timeout http-request <timeout>
9332 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009334 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009335 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009336 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009337 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9338 as explained at the top of this document.
9339
9340 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9341 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9342 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9343 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9344 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9345 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9346 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009347 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9348 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9349 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9350 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9351 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009352 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9353 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009354
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009355 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9356 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9357 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9358 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9359 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009360 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009361
9362 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9363 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9364 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9365 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9366 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9367
9368 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009369 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9370 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9371 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009372
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009373 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009374 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009375
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009376
9377timeout queue <timeout>
9378 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9380 yes | no | yes | yes
9381 Arguments :
9382 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9384 as explained at the top of this document.
9385
9386 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9387 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9388 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9389 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9390 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9391
9392 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9393 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9394 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9395 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9396
9397 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9398
9399
9400timeout server <timeout>
9401timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9402 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9404 yes | no | yes | yes
9405 Arguments :
9406 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9407 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9408 as explained at the top of this document.
9409
9410 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9411 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9412 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9413 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9414 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9415 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9416 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9417
9418 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9419 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9420 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9421 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9422 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009423 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009424 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009425 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9426 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9427 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9428 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009429
9430 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9431 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9432 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9433 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9434 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9435 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9436
9437 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9438 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9439 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9440
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009441 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009442
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009443
9444timeout server-fin <timeout>
9445 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9447 yes | no | yes | yes
9448 Arguments :
9449 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9450 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9451 as explained at the top of this document.
9452
9453 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9454 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9455 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9456 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9457 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9458 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9459 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9460 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9461 situations, it should not be needed.
9462
9463 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9464 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9465 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9466
9467 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9468
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009469
9470timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009471 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9473 yes | yes | yes | yes
9474 Arguments :
9475 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9476 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9477 as explained at the top of this document.
9478
9479 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9480 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9481 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9482
9483 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9484 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9485 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9486 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009487 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009488
9489 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9490
9491
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009492timeout tunnel <timeout>
9493 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9495 yes | no | yes | yes
9496 Arguments :
9497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9499 as explained at the top of this document.
9500
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009501 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009502 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9503 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9504 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9505 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9506 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9507 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9508 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9509 specified.
9510
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009511 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9512 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9513 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9514 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9515 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9516 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9517 state.
9518
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009519 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9520 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9521 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9522 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9523 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9524
9525 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9526 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9527 forget about it.
9528
9529 Example :
9530 defaults http
9531 option http-server-close
9532 timeout connect 5s
9533 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009534 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009535 timeout server 30s
9536 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9537
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009538 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009539
9540
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009541transparent (deprecated)
9542 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009544 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009545 Arguments : none
9546
9547 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9548 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9549 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9550 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9551 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9552 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9553 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9554 appropriate server.
9555
9556 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9557
9558 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9559 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9560
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009561 See also: "option transparent"
9562
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009563unique-id-format <string>
9564 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9566 yes | yes | yes | no
9567 Arguments :
9568 <string> is a log-format string.
9569
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009570 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9571 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9572 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9573 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009574
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009575 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9576 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9577 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9578 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9579 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9580 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9581 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9582 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009583
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009584 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9585 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009586
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009587 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009588
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009589 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009590
9591 will generate:
9592
9593 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9594
9595 See also: "unique-id-header"
9596
9597unique-id-header <name>
9598 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9600 yes | yes | yes | no
9601 Arguments :
9602 <name> is the name of the header.
9603
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009604 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9605 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009606
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009607 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009608
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009609 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009610 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9611
9612 will generate:
9613
9614 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9615
9616 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009617
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009618use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009619 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9621 no | yes | yes | no
9622 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009623 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9624 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009625
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009626 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9627 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009628
9629 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9630 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9631 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009632 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9633 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9634 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9635 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009636
9637 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9638 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9639 assign the backend.
9640
9641 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9642 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9643 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9644 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9645 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9646 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9647
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009648 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009649 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009650 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9651 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9652 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9653
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009654 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9655 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9656 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9657 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9658 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9659 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9660 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9661 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9662 cannot be forced from the request.
9663
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009664 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009665 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9666 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9667
9668 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9669 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009670
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009671
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009672use-server <server> if <condition>
9673use-server <server> unless <condition>
9674 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9676 no | no | yes | yes
9677 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009678 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009679
9680 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9681
9682 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9683 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9684 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9685
9686 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9687 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9688 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9689 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9690 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9691 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9692 matches will assign the server.
9693
9694 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9695 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9696 with the next rules until one matches.
9697
9698 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9699 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9700 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9701 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9702
9703 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9704 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9705 stripped.
9706
9707 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9708 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9709 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9710 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9711
9712 Example :
9713 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9714 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9715 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9716 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9717 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9718 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9719 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9720 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9721 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9722
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009723 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009724
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009725
97265. Bind and Server options
9727--------------------------
9728
9729The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9730depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9731settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9732written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9733described in this section.
9734
9735
97365.1. Bind options
9737-----------------
9738
9739The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9740as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9741no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9742parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9743while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9744provided immediately after the setting name.
9745
9746The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9747
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009748accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9749 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9750 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9751 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9752 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9753 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9754 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
9755 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
9756 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
9757 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009758 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
9759 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
9760 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009761
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009762accept-proxy
9763 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009764 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9765 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009766 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9767 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9768 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9769 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9770 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9771 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9772 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009773 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9774 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009775
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009776alpn <protocols>
9777 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9778 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9779 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9780 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9781 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9782 initial NPN extension.
9783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009784backlog <backlog>
9785 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9786 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9787
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009788ecdhe <named curve>
9789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009790 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9791 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009792
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009793ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9795 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9796 client's certificate.
9797
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009798ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9799 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9800 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9801 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9802 error is ignored.
9803
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009804ca-sign-file <cafile>
9805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9806 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9807 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9808 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9809 'generate-certificates' for details.
9810
9811ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9813 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9814 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9815 'generate-certificates' for details.
9816
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009817ciphers <ciphers>
9818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9819 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009820 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009821 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9822 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9823
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009824crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9826 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9827 to verify client's certificate.
9828
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009829crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9831 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9832 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9833 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9834 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9835 file.
9836
9837 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9838 are loaded.
9839
9840 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009841 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009842 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9843 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9844 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9845 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9846 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9847 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9848 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009849
9850 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9851 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9852 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9853 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009854 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9855 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009856
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009857 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009858
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009859 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9860 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009861 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009862 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9863 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9864 clients).
9865
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009866 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9867 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9868 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9869 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9870 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9871 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9872 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9873 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9874 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9875 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9876 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9877 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9878 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9879
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009880 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9881 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9882 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9883 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9884 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9885
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009886 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
9887 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
9888 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
9889 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009890
9891 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
9892 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
9893 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
9894 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
9895 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
9896 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
9897 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
9898 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
9899 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
9900
9901 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
9902
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009903 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009904 a cert bundle.
9905
9906 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
9907 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
9908 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
9909 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
9910 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
9911 provide multi-cert support.
9912
9913 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
9914
9915 Filename | CN | SAN
9916 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9917 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009918 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009919 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
9920 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9921
9922 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
9923 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
9924 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
9925 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
9926 suites.
9927
9928 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
9929 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
9930
9931 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
9932 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
9933 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
9934
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009935crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9937 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009938 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009939 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009940
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009941crt-list <file>
9942 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009943 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9944 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009945
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009946 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009947
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009948 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9949 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9950 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9951 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9952 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9953 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9954 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9955 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009956
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009957 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +02009958 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
9959 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009960
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009961defer-accept
9962 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9963 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9964 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9965 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9966 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9967 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9968 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9969 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9970 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9971 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9972 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9973
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009974force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009975 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009976 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009977 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9978 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009979
9980force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009981 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009982 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9983 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009984
9985force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009986 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009987 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9988 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009989
9990force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009991 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009992 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9993 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009994
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009995generate-certificates
9996 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9997 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9998 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9999 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10000 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10001 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10002 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10003 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10004 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10005 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10006 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10007
10008 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10009 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10010 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10011 certificate is used many times.
10012
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010013gid <gid>
10014 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10015 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10016 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10017 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10018 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10019
10020group <group>
10021 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10022 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10023 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10024 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10025 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10026
10027id <id>
10028 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10029 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10030 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10031 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10032
10033interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010034 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10035 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10036 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10037 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10038 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10039 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10040 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010041
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010042level <level>
10043 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10044 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10045 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10046 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10047 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10048 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10049 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10050 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10051 counters).
10052 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10053 all counters).
10054
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010055maxconn <maxconn>
10056 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10057 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10058 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10059 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10060 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10061 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10062 eat all memory.
10063
10064mode <mode>
10065 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10066 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10067 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10068 UNIX sockets.
10069
10070mss <maxseg>
10071 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10072 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10073 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10074 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10075 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10076 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10077 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10078 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10079 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10080 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10081 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10082
10083name <name>
10084 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10085 page.
10086
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010087namespace <name>
10088 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10089 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10090 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10091 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10092
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010093nice <nice>
10094 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10095 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10096 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10097 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10098 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10099 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10100 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10101 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10102 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10103 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10104 one for an RDP socket.
10105
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010106no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010107 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010108 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010109 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010110 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10111 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010112 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010113
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010114no-tls-tickets
10115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10116 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10117 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010118 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10119 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010120
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010121no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010123 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010124 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010125 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10126 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10127 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010128
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010129no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010130 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010131 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010132 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010133 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10134 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10135 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010136
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010137no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010139 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010140 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010141 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10142 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10143 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010144
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010145npn <protocols>
10146 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10147 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10148 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10149 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010150 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10151 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010152
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010153process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10154 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10155 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10156 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10157 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10158 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10159 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10160 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010161 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10162 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10163 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10164 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10165 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10166 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10167 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010168
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010169ssl
10170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010171 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010172 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10173 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10174 to deciphered contents.
10175
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010176strict-sni
10177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10178 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10179 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10180 See the "crt" option for more information.
10181
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010182tcp-ut <delay>
10183 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10184 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10185 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10186 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10187 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10188 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10189 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10190 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10191 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10192 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10193 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10194
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010195tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010196 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010197 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10198 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10199 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10200 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10201 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10202 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10203 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010204 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10205 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10206 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010207
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010208tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10209 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10210 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10211 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10212 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10213 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10214 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10215 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10216 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10217 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10218 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10219
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010220transparent
10221 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10222 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10223 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10224 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10225 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10226 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10227 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10228 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10229 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10230 so check for support with your vendor.
10231
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010232v4v6
10233 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10234 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10235 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10236 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010237 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010238
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010239v6only
10240 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10241 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10242 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010243 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10244 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010245
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010246uid <uid>
10247 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10248 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10249 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10250 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10251 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10252
10253user <user>
10254 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10255 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10256 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10257 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10258 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10259
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010260verify [none|optional|required]
10261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10262 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10263 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10264 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10265 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010266 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10267 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10268 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10269 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010270
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200102715.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010272------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010274The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10275which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10276arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10277settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10278after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10279Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10280address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010282 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010283 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010285The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010286
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010287addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010288 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010289 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10290 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10291 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10292 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10293 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010295 Supported in default-server: No
10296
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010297agent-check
10298 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010299 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10300 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10301 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10302 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010303
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010304 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010305 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010306 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10307 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10308 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010309
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010310 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10311 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10312 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10313 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10314 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10315
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010316 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10317 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010318
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010319 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10320 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10321 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010322
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010323 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10324 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10325 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010326
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010327 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10328 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10329 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10330 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10331 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10332 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10333 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010334
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010335 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10336 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010337
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010338 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10339 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10340 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10341 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10342 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10343 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10344 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10345 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10346 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010347
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010348 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10349 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010350 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10351 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10352 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010353 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010354
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010355 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10356 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010357
10358 Supported in default-server: No
10359
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010360agent-send <string>
10361 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10362 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10363 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10364 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10365 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10366
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010367agent-inter <delay>
10368 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10369 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10370
10371 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10372 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10373 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10374 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10375 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10376 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10377 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10378 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10379 of backends use the same servers.
10380
10381 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10382
10383 Supported in default-server: Yes
10384
10385agent-port <port>
10386 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10387
10388 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10389
10390 Supported in default-server: Yes
10391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010392backup
10393 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10394 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10395 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10396 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10397 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10398 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010400 Supported in default-server: No
10401
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010402ca-file <cafile>
10403 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10404 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10405 server's certificate.
10406
10407 Supported in default-server: No
10408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010409check
10410 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010411 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10412 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10413 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10414 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10415 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10416 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10417 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010418 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10419 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10420 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010422 Supported in default-server: No
10423
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010424check-send-proxy
10425 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10426 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10427 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10428 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10429 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10430 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10431 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10432
10433 Supported in default-server: No
10434
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010435check-ssl
10436 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10437 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10438 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10439 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010440 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010441 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10442 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10443 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10444 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10445
10446 Supported in default-server: No
10447
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010448ciphers <ciphers>
10449 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010450 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010451 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10452 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10453 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10454 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10455 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10456 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10457
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010458 Supported in default-server: No
10459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010460cookie <value>
10461 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10462 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10463 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10464 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10465 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10466 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10467 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010469 Supported in default-server: No
10470
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010471crl-file <crlfile>
10472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10473 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10474 to verify server's certificate.
10475
10476 Supported in default-server: No
10477
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010478crt <cert>
10479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10480 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10481 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10482 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10483 certificate request.
10484
10485 Supported in default-server: No
10486
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010487disabled
10488 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10489 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10490 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10491 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10492 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10493
10494 Supported in default-server: No
10495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010496error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010497 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10498 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10499 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010501 Supported in default-server: Yes
10502
10503 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010505fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010506 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10507 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10508 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010510 Supported in default-server: Yes
10511
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010512force-sslv3
10513 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10514 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010515 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10516 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010517
10518 Supported in default-server: No
10519
10520force-tlsv10
10521 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010522 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10523 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010524
10525 Supported in default-server: No
10526
10527force-tlsv11
10528 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010529 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10530 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010531
10532 Supported in default-server: No
10533
10534force-tlsv12
10535 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010536 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10537 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010538
10539 Supported in default-server: No
10540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010541id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010542 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10543 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10544 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010546 Supported in default-server: No
10547
10548inter <delay>
10549fastinter <delay>
10550downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010551 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10552 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10553 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10554 between checks depending on the server state :
10555
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010556 Server state | Interval used
10557 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10558 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10559 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10560 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10561 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10562 or yet unchecked. |
10563 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10564 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10565 | "inter" otherwise.
10566 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010568 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10569 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10570 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10571 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010572 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10573 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10574 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10575 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10576 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010578 Supported in default-server: Yes
10579
10580maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010581 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10582 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10583 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10584 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10585 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10586 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10587 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10588 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010590 Supported in default-server: Yes
10591
10592maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010593 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10594 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10595 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10596 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10597 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10598 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10599 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010601 Supported in default-server: Yes
10602
10603minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010604 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10605 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10606 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10607 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10608 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10609 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010610 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010611 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010613 Supported in default-server: Yes
10614
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010615namespace <name>
10616 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10617 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10618 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10619 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10620
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010621no-ssl-reuse
10622 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10623 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10624 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10625 and for paranoid users.
10626
10627 Supported in default-server: No
10628
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010629no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010630 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10631 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010632 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010633
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010634 Supported in default-server: No
10635
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010636no-tls-tickets
10637 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10638 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10639 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010640 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10641 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010642
10643 Supported in default-server: No
10644
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010645no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010646 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010647 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10648 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010649 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10650 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10651 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010652
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010653 Supported in default-server: No
10654
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010655no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010656 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010657 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10658 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010659 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10660 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10661 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010662
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010663 Supported in default-server: No
10664
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010665no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010666 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010667 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10668 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010669 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10670 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10671 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010672
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010673 Supported in default-server: No
10674
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010675non-stick
10676 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10677 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10678 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10679
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010680 Supported in default-server: No
10681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010682observe <mode>
10683 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10684 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10685 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10686 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10687 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10688 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010689 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010691 Supported in default-server: No
10692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010693 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010695on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010696 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10697 Currently, four modes are available:
10698 - fastinter: force fastinter
10699 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10700 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10701 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10702 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010704 Supported in default-server: Yes
10705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010706 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10707
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010708on-marked-down <action>
10709 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10710 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010711 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10712 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10713 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10714 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10715 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10716 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10717 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10718 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010719
10720 Actions are disabled by default
10721
10722 Supported in default-server: Yes
10723
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010724on-marked-up <action>
10725 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10726 Currently one action is available:
10727 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10728 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10729 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10730 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10731 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10732 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10733 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10734 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10735
10736 Actions are disabled by default
10737
10738 Supported in default-server: Yes
10739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010740port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010741 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10742 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10743 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10744 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10745 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10746 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010748 Supported in default-server: Yes
10749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010750redir <prefix>
10751 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10752 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10753 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10754 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10755 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10756 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10757 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10758 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010759 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010760 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10761 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10762 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10763 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10764 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10765
10766 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010768 Supported in default-server: No
10769
10770rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010771 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10772 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10773 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010775 Supported in default-server: Yes
10776
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010777resolve-prefer <family>
10778 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10779 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10780 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10781 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10782
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010783 Default value: ipv6
10784
10785 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010786
10787 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10788
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010789resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10790 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10791 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10792 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10793 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10794 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10795 configured network, another address is selected.
10796
10797 Supported in default-server: Yes
10798
10799 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
10800
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010801resolvers <id>
10802 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10803 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010804 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10805 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10806 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10807 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010808
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010809 Supported in default-server: No
10810
10811 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010812
10813 See also chapter 5.3
10814
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010815send-proxy
10816 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10817 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10818 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10819 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010820 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
10821 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
10822 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
10823 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
10824 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
10825 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
10826 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
10827 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
10828 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
10829 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
10830 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
10831 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010832
10833 Supported in default-server: No
10834
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010835send-proxy-v2
10836 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10837 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10838 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10839 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10840 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10841 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10842 option of the "bind" keyword.
10843
10844 Supported in default-server: No
10845
10846send-proxy-v2-ssl
10847 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10848 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10849 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10850 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10851 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10852 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10853 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10854 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10855
10856 Supported in default-server: No
10857
10858send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10859 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10860 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10861 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10862 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10863 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10864 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10865 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10866 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10867 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10868
10869 Supported in default-server: No
10870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010871slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010872 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10873 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10874 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10875 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10876 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10877 parameters :
10878
10879 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10880 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10881
10882 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10883 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10884 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10885 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10886
10887 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10888 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10889 seen as failed.
10890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010891 Supported in default-server: Yes
10892
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010893sni <expression>
10894 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10895 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10896 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10897 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10898 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10899
10900 Supported in default-server: no
10901
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010902source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010903source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010904source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010905 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10906 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10907 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10908 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10909
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010910 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10911 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10912 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10913 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10914 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10915 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10916 server.
10917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010918 Supported in default-server: No
10919
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010920ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010921 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10922 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10923 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10924 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10925 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10926 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010927 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010928
10929 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010930
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010931tcp-ut <delay>
10932 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10933 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10934 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10935 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10936 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10937 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10938 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10939 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10940 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10941 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10942 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10943 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10944 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010946track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010947 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10948 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10949 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10950 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010951 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010953 Supported in default-server: No
10954
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010955verify [none|required]
10956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010957 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10958 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10959 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10960 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010961 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10962 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10963 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010964
10965 Supported in default-server: No
10966
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010967verifyhost <hostname>
10968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10969 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10970 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10971 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10972 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10973 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10974
10975 Supported in default-server: No
10976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010977weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010978 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10979 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10980 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010981 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10982 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10983 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10984 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10985 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10986 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010988 Supported in default-server: Yes
10989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010990
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200109915.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10992-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010993
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010994HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
10995using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10996configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010997This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10998can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10999workload.
11000This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11001resolution at run time.
11002Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11003carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11004
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011005Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11006health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11007
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011008
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110095.3.1. Global overview
11010----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011011
11012As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11013different steps of the process life:
11014
11015 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11016 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11017 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11018
11019 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11020 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11021 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11022
11023A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11024 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11025 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11026 resolution to know this new IP.
11027
11028A few things important to notice:
11029 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11030 first valid response.
11031
11032 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11033 servers return an error.
11034
11035
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110365.3.2. The resolvers section
11037----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011038
11039This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11040HAProxy.
11041There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11042many name servers.
11043
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011044When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11045uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11046is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11047answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11048
11049When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11050used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11051
11052Two types of behavior can be applied:
11053 1. stop DNS resolution
11054 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11055 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11056 1. ANY query type
11057 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11058 server's parameter
11059 3. remaining family type
11060
11061HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11062 - invalid DNS response packet
11063 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11064 - NX domain
11065 - Query refused by server
11066 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11067
11068HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11069 - no Answer records in the response
11070 - DNS response truncated
11071 - Error in DNS response
11072 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11073 - name server timeout
11074
11075For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11076 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11077 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11078 applied;
11079 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11080 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11081 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11082 stops resolution.
11083
11084
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011085resolvers <resolvers id>
11086 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11087
11088A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11089
11090nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11091 DNS server description:
11092 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11093 <ip> : IP address of the server
11094 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11095
11096hold <status> <period>
11097 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11098 on last resolution <status>
11099 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
11100 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11101 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11102 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11103
11104 Default value is 10s for "valid".
11105
11106 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11107 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11108 the healch check.
11109
11110resolve_retries <nb>
11111 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11112 giving up.
11113 Default value: 3
11114
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011115 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11116 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11117 type.
11118
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011119timeout <event> <time>
11120 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11121 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11122 events available are:
11123 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11124 been received.
11125 Default value: 1s
11126 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11127 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11128
11129Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
11130
11131 resolvers mydns
11132 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11133 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11134 resolve_retries 3
11135 timeout retry 1s
11136 hold valid 10s
11137
11138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111396. HTTP header manipulation
11140---------------------------
11141
11142In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11143response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11144request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11145which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011146against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011147
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011148If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11149to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11150but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11151HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11152stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11153because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11154a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11155still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011157This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11158in section 4.2 :
11159
11160 - reqadd <string>
11161 - reqallow <search>
11162 - reqiallow <search>
11163 - reqdel <search>
11164 - reqidel <search>
11165 - reqdeny <search>
11166 - reqideny <search>
11167 - reqpass <search>
11168 - reqipass <search>
11169 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11170 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11171 - reqtarpit <search>
11172 - reqitarpit <search>
11173 - rspadd <string>
11174 - rspdel <search>
11175 - rspidel <search>
11176 - rspdeny <search>
11177 - rspideny <search>
11178 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11179 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11180
11181With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11182is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11183parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11184prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11185Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11186
11187 \t for a tab
11188 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11189 \n for a new line (LF)
11190 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11191 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11192 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11193 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11194 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11195
11196The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11197portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11198above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11199regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
112009 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11201is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11202
11203The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11204after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11205
11206Notes related to these keywords :
11207---------------------------------
11208 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11209 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11210 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11211
11212 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11213 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11214 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11215
11216 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11217 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11218 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11219 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11220 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11221
11222 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11223 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11224 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11225 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11226 useless headers before adding new ones.
11227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011228 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011229 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11230
11231 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11232 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11233 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11234
11235 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11236 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011237 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011238
11239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112407. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11241----------------------------------
11242
11243Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11244client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11245The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11246these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11247but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11248data called patterns.
11249
11250
112517.1. ACL basics
11252---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011253
11254The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11255content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11256from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11257simple :
11258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011259 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011260 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011261 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11262 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011264The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11265adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011266
11267In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011269 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011270
11271This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11272Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11273and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011274an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11275conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11276as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11277are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011278
11279ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11280'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11281which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11282
11283There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11284performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011286The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11287specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11288this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011289methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11290ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011291
11292Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11293 - boolean
11294 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11295 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11296 - string
11297 - data block
11298
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011299Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11300converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11301would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11302The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11303which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11304
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011305Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11306keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11307fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11308which are summarized in the table below :
11309
11310 +---------------------+-----------------+
11311 | Sample or converter | Default |
11312 | output type | matching method |
11313 +---------------------+-----------------+
11314 | boolean | bool |
11315 +---------------------+-----------------+
11316 | integer | int |
11317 +---------------------+-----------------+
11318 | ip | ip |
11319 +---------------------+-----------------+
11320 | string | str |
11321 +---------------------+-----------------+
11322 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11323 +---------------------+-----------------+
11324
11325Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11326matching method, see below.
11327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11329 - boolean
11330 - integer or integer range
11331 - IP address / network
11332 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11333 - regular expression
11334 - hex block
11335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011336The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11337
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011338 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11339 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011340 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011341 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011342 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011343 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011344 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011346The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11347read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11348if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11349lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11350will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11351beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11352a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11353lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11354exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11355
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011356The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11357parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11358ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11359a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11360check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11361
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011362The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11363socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11364file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011366Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11367loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11368
11369 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11370
11371In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11372the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11373case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11374as well.
11375
11376The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11377sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11378do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11379methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11380is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11381obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11382followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11383default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11384that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11385string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11386
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011387The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11388By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11389string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11390resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11391server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11392waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11393flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11394function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011396There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11397sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11398be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011399
11400 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11401 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011402 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11403 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11404 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11405 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011406
11407 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11408 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011409 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011410
11411 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011412 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011413
11414 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011415 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011416
11417 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11418 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11419
11420 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11421 binary or string samples.
11422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011423 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11424 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11427 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11428 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011430 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11431 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011433 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11434 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011436 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11437 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011439 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11440 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011441 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011443 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11444 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11445 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011446
11447For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11448request, it is possible to do :
11449
11450 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11451
11452In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11453buffer, one would use the following acl :
11454
11455 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11456
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011457On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11458possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11459
11460 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011462All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11463criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11464method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11465to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11466criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11467the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011469If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011470the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11471For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011473 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11474 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11475 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11476 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011477
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011478
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011479The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11480types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11481combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11482brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11483default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011485 +-------------------------------------------------+
11486 | Input sample type |
11487 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011488 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011489 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11490 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11491 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011492 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011494 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011495 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011496 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011497 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011498 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011499 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011500 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011501 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011502 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011503 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011504 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011505 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011506 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011508 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011509 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011510 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011511 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011512 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011513 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11514 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11515 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011516
11517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115187.1.1. Matching booleans
11519------------------------
11520
11521In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11522Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11523When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11524that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11525
11526Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11527return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11528"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11529
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115317.1.2. Matching integers
11532------------------------
11533
11534Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11535enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11536to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11537
11538Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11539matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11540lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011541
11542For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11543unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11544representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11545
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011546As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11547two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11548instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11549ranges and operators.
11550
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011551For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011552operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11553Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11554of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011556Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011557
11558 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11559 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11560 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11561 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11562 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011564For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011565
11566 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11567
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011568This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11569
11570 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115737.1.3. Matching strings
11574-----------------------
11575
11576String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11577different forms :
11578
11579 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11580 patterns ;
11581
11582 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11583 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11584
11585 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11586 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11587
11588 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11589 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11590
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011591 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011592 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11593 matches.
11594
11595 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11596 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11597 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011598
11599String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11600exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11601characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11602string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11603to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011604before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011605
11606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116077.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11608---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011609
11610Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11611they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11612possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11613passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11614the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011615the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11616match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011617
11618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116197.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11620-------------------------------------
11621
11622It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11623not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11624a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11625to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11626digits may be used upper or lower case.
11627
11628Example :
11629 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11630 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11631
11632
116337.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11634---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011635
11636IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11637netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11638within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011639host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011640difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11641at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11642does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11643parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011644
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011645The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11646abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11647
11648 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11649 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11650 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11651 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11652 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11653 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11654 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11655 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11656
11657Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11658192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11659
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011660IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11661Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11662trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11663IPv6 patterns.
11664
11665HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11666following situations :
11667 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11668 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11669 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11670 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11671 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11672 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11673 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11674 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11675 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11676 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011678
116797.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11680----------------------------------
11681
11682Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11683combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11684
11685 - AND (implicit)
11686 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11687 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011689A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011691 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011693Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11694indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011696For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11697"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11698requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11699is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11700
11701 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11702 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11703 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11704 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11705
11706To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11707and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11708
11709 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11710 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11711 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11712 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11713
11714 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11715 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11716 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11717 use_backend www if host_www
11718
11719It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11720expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11721be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11722the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11723
11724 The following rule :
11725
11726 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11727 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11728
11729 Can also be written that way :
11730
11731 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11732
11733It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11734to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11735simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11736sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11737good use is the following :
11738
11739 With named ACLs :
11740
11741 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11742 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11743 monitor fail if site_dead
11744
11745 With anonymous ACLs :
11746
11747 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11748
11749See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11750
11751
117527.3. Fetching samples
11753---------------------
11754
11755Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11756against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11757sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11758ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11759of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11760available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11761
11762This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11763Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11764compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11765deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11766
11767The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11768matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11769method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11770indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11771
11772As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11773when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11774mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11775the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11776ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11777
11778Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11779multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11780when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11781incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11782are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11783is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11784all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11785
11786Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11787 - name
11788 - name(arg1)
11789 - name(arg1,arg2)
11790
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011791
117927.3.1. Converters
11793-----------------
11794
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011795Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11796of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11797is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11798was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11799has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11800unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11801
11802These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11803sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11804the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11805support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011806
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011807A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11808support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11809supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11810(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11811bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011813The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011814
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011815add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011816 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011817 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011818 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11819 scopes allowed are:
11820 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11821 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11822 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11823 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11824 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011825 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011826
11827and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011828 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011829 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011830 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11831 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11832 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11833 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11834 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11835 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11836 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011837 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011838
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011839base64
11840 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11841 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11842 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11843
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011844bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011845 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011846 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11847 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11848 presence of a flag).
11849
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011850bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11851 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11852 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11853 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11854
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011855cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011856 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11857 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011858
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011859crc32([<avalanche>])
11860 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11861 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11862 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11863 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11864 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11865 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11866 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11867 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11868 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11869 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11870 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11871
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011872da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011873 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11874 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11875 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11876 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011877 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011878 configuration language.
11879
11880 Example:
11881 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011882 bind *:8881
11883 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011884 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011885
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011886debug
11887 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11888 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11889 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11890
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011891div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011892 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11893 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011894 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011895 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11896 scope. The scopes allowed are:
11897 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11898 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11899 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11900 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11901 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011902 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011903
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011904djb2([<avalanche>])
11905 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11906 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11907 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11908 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11909 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11910 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11911 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011912 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11913 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011914
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011915even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011916 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011917 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11918
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011919field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11920 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11921 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11922 list of chars.
11923
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011924hex
11925 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11926 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11927 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11928 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011929
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011930http_date([<offset>])
11931 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11932 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11933 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11934 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11935 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11936 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011937
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011938in_table(<table>)
11939 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11940 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11941 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11942 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11943 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11944
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011945ipmask(<mask>)
11946 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11947 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11948 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11949 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11950
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011951json([<input-code>])
11952 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11953 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11954 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11955 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11956 of errors:
11957 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11958 bytes, ...)
11959 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11960 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11961
11962 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11963 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11964 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11965 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11966 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11967 are :
11968 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11969 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11970 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11971 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11972 error ;
11973 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11974 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11975
11976 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11977 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11978
11979 Example:
11980 capture request header user-agent len 150
11981 capture request header Host len 15
Mac Browninge83345d2016-03-14 14:46:01 -040011982 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json("utf8s")]"}
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011983
11984 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11985 GET / HTTP/1.0
11986 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11987
11988 Output log:
11989 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11990
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011991language(<value>[,<default>])
11992 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11993 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11994 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11995 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11996 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11997 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11998 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11999 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12000 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12001 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12002 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12003 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012004
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012005 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012006
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012007 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12008 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012010 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12011 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12012 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12013 use_backend spanish if es
12014 use_backend french if fr
12015 use_backend english if en
12016 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012017
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012018lower
12019 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12020 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12021 type. The result is of type string.
12022
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012023ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12024 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12025 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12026 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12027 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12028 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12029 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12030
12031 Example :
12032
12033 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12034 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12035 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12036
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012037map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12038map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12039map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12040 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12041 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12042 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12043 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12044 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12045 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12046 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12047 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012048
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012049 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12050 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12051 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012052
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012053 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12054 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012055
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012056 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12057 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12058 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12059 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012060 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12061 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012062 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12063 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12064 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12065 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12066 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12067 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12068 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12069 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012070 | | map_reg | |
12071 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12072 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012073 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12074 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12075 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12076 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12077 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012078
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012079 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12080 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12081 the corresponding match text.
12082
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012083 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12084 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12085 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12086 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12087 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012088
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012089 Example :
12090
12091 # this is a comment and is ignored
12092 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12093 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12094 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12095 | | | `---------- value
12096 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12097 | `---------------------------- key
12098 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12099
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012100mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012101 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12102 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012103 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012104 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12105 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12106 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12107 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12108 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12109 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012110 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012111
12112mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012113 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012114 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12115 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012116 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012117 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12118 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12119 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12120 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12121 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12122 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012123 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012124
12125neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012126 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12127 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12128 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12129 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012130
12131not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012132 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012133 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12134 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12135 absence of a flag).
12136
12137odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012138 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012139 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12140
12141or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012142 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012143 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012144 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12145 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12146 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12147 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12148 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12149 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12150 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012151 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012152
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012153regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012154 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12155 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12156 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12157 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12158 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12159 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12160 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12161 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12162 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12163 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012164 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12165 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12166 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12167 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012168
12169 Example :
12170
12171 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12172 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12173 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12174 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12175
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012176capture-req(<id>)
12177 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12178 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12179
12180 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012181 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12182 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012183
12184capture-res(<id>)
12185 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12186 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12187
12188 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012189 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12190 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012191
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012192sdbm([<avalanche>])
12193 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12194 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12195 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12196 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12197 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12198 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12199 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012200 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12201 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012202
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012203set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012204 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12205 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12206 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12207 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12208 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012209 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012210 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12211 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012212 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12213 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12214
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012215sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012216 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12217 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012218 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012219 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12220 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12221 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12222 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012223 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012224 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12225 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012226 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12227 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012228
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012229table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12230 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12231 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12232 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12233 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12234 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12235 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12236
12237
12238table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12239 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12240 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12241 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12242 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12243 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12244 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12245
12246table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12247 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12248 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12249 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12250 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12251 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12252
12253table_conn_cur(<table>)
12254 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12255 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12256 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12257 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12258 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12259
12260table_conn_rate(<table>)
12261 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12262 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12263 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12264 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12265 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12266
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012267table_gpt0(<table>)
12268 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12269 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12270 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12271 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12272 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12273
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012274table_gpc0(<table>)
12275 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12276 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12277 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12278 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12279 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12280
12281table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12282 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12283 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12284 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12285 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12286 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12287 sample fetch keyword.
12288
12289table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12290 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12291 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12292 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12293 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12294 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12295
12296table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12297 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12298 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12299 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12300 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12301 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12302 keyword.
12303
12304table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12305 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12306 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12307 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12308 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12309 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12310
12311table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12312 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12313 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12314 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12315 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12316 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12317 keyword.
12318
12319table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12320 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12321 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12322 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12323 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12324 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12325 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12326 keyword.
12327
12328table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12329 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12330 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12331 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12332 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12333 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12334 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12335 keyword.
12336
12337table_server_id(<table>)
12338 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12339 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12340 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12341 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12342 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12343 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12344
12345table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12346 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12347 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12348 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12349 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12350 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12351 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12352 keyword.
12353
12354table_sess_rate(<table>)
12355 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12356 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12357 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12358 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12359 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12360 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12361 keyword.
12362
12363table_trackers(<table>)
12364 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12365 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12366 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12367 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12368 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12369 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12370 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12371 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12372 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12373 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12374
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012375upper
12376 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12377 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12378 type. The result is of type string.
12379
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012380url_dec
12381 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12382 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12383
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012384utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12385 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12386 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12387 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12388 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12389 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12390 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12391
12392 Example :
12393
12394 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12395 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12396 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12397
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012398word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12399 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12400 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12401
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012402wt6([<avalanche>])
12403 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12404 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12405 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12406 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12407 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12408 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12409 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012410 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12411 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012412
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012413xor(<value>)
12414 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012415 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012416 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012417 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12418 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12419 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012420 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012421 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12422 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012423 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12424 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012425
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012426
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124277.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012428--------------------------------------------
12429
12430A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12431not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12432"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12433The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12434
12435always_false : boolean
12436 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12437 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12438
12439always_true : boolean
12440 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12441 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12442
12443avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012444 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012445 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12446 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12447 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12448 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12449 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12450 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12451 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12452 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12453 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12454 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12455 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12456 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12457 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012459be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012460 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12461 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12462 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12463 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12464 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012466be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12467 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12468 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12469 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12470 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12471 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12472 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012473
12474 Example :
12475 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12476 backend dynamic
12477 mode http
12478 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12479 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012480
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012481bin(<hexa>) : bin
12482 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12483 of the string.
12484
12485bool(<bool>) : bool
12486 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12487 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012489connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12490 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012491 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012492 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12493 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012494
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012495 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012496 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012497 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12498
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012499 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12500 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012501
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012502 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012503 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012504 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012505 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12506 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012507 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012508 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012509
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012510 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12511 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012512 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012513 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012514
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012515date([<offset>]) : integer
12516 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12517 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12518 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12519 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012520 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12521
12522 Example :
12523
12524 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12525 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012526
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012527env(<name>) : string
12528 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12529 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12530 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12531 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12532 certain way.
12533
12534 Examples :
12535 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12536 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12537
12538 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12539 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012541fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12542 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012543 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12544 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012545 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12546 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12547 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12548 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12549 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012551fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12552 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12553 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12554 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12555 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12556 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12557 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12558 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12559 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012560
12561 Example :
12562 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12563 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12564 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12565 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12566 frontend mail
12567 bind :25
12568 mode tcp
12569 maxconn 100
12570 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12571 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12572 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12573 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012574
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012575int(<integer>) : signed integer
12576 Returns a signed integer.
12577
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012578ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12579 Returns an ipv4.
12580
12581ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12582 Returns an ipv6.
12583
12584meth(<method>) : method
12585 Returns a method.
12586
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012587nbproc : integer
12588 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12589 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12590 and debugging purposes.
12591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012592nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12594 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12595 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012596 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12597 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12598 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012599
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012600proc : integer
12601 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12602 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12603 debugging purposes.
12604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012605queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012606 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12607 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12608 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012609 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12610 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12611 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12612 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12613 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12614
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012615rand([<range>]) : integer
12616 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12617 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12618 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12619 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12620 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012622srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12624 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12625 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12626 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12627 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12628 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12629 methods.
12630
12631srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12632 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12633 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12634 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12635 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12636 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12637 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12638 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12639
12640srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12641 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12642 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012643 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012644 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12645 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12646 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12647 overloading servers).
12648
12649 Example :
12650 # Redirect to a separate back
12651 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12652 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12653 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12654
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012655stopping : boolean
12656 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12657 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12658 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12659
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012660str(<string>) : string
12661 Returns a string.
12662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012663table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12664 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12665 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12666
12667table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12668 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12669 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12670 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12671
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012672var(<var-name>) : undefined
12673 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012674 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12675 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12676 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12677 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012678 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012679 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12680 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012681 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12682 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12683
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200126847.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012685----------------------------------
12686
12687The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12688closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12689methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12690sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12691TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012692the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12693counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12694"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012695argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12696the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12697this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012698
12699be_id : integer
12700 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12701 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12702
12703dst : ip
12704 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12705 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12706 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12707 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12708 RFC 4291.
12709
12710dst_conn : integer
12711 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12712 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12713 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12714 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12715 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12716 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12717 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12718 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012720dst_port : integer
12721 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12722 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12723 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12724 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12725 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12726 an HTTP header.
12727
12728fe_id : integer
12729 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12730 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12731 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12732
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012733sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012734sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12735sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12736sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012737 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12738 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12739 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12740
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012741sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012742sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12743sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12744sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012745 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12746 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12747 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12748
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012749sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012750sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12751sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12752sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012753 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12754 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012755 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12756 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12757 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012758
12759 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12760 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012761 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12762 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12763 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012764 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12765 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12766
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012767sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012768sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12769sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12770sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012771 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12772 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12773
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012774sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012775sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12776sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12777sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012778 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12779 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12780 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12781
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012782sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012783sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12784sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12785sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012786 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12787 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12788 See also src_conn_rate.
12789
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012790sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012791sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12792sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12793sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012794 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012795 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012796
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012797sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12798sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12799sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12800sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12801 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12802 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12803
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012804sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012805sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12806sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12807sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012808 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12809 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12810 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012811 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12812 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12813 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012814
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012815sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012816sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12817sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12818sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012819 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12820 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12821 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12822
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012823sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012824sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12825sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12826sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012827 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12828 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12829 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12830 src_http_err_rate.
12831
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012832sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012833sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12834sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12835sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012836 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12837 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12838 src_http_req_cnt.
12839
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012840sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012841sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12842sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12843sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012844 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12845 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12846 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12847 src_http_req_rate.
12848
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012849sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012850sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12851sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12852sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012853 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012854 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12855 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12856 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12857 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012858
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012859 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12860 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012861 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12862
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012863sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012864sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12865sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12866sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012867 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12868 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12869 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012870
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012871sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012872sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12873sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12874sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012875 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12876 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12877 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012878
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012879sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012880sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12881sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12882sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012883 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12884 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12885 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12886 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012887 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012888 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12889
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012890sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012891sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12892sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12893sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012894 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12895 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12896 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12897 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12898 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012899 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012900
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012901sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012902sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12903sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12904sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012905 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12906 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12907 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12908
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012909sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012910sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12911sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12912sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012913 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12914 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012915 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012916 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12917 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12919 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12920 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012922so_id : integer
12923 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12924 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12925 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012927src : ip
12928 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12929 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12930 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12931 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012932 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
12933 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
12934 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
12935 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012936
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012937 Example:
12938 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12939 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012941src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12942 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12943 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12944 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012945 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012947src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12948 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12949 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012950 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012951 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12954 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12955 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12956 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12957 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12958 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12959 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012960
12961 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12962 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12963 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12964 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012965 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012966 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12967 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012969src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012970 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012971 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012972 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012973 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012975src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012976 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012977 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12978 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012979 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012981src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12982 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12983 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12984 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012985 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012987src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012988 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012990 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012991 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012992
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012993src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12994 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12995 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12996 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
12997 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
12998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012999src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013000 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013002 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13003 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013004 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13005 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13006 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013008src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13009 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13010 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013011 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013012 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013013 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013015src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13016 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13017 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13018 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13019 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013020 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013022src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13023 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13024 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13025 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013026 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013028src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13029 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13030 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13031 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013032 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013033 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013035src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13036 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13037 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13038 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013039 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13041 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013042
13043 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013044 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013045 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013048 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13049 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13050 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13051 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13052 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013054src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013055 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13056 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13057 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13058 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13059 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013061src_port : integer
13062 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13063 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13064 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13065 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013067src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13068 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013069 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13070 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13071 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013072 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013074src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13075 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13076 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13077 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13078 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013079 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013081src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13082 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13083 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13084 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13085 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13086 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13087 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13088 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13089 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013090
13091 Example :
13092 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13093 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13094 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13095 listen ssh
13096 bind :22
13097 mode tcp
13098 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013099 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013100 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013101 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013103srv_id : integer
13104 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13105 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13106 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013107
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010013108
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200131097.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013110----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13113closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13114when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13115usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013116future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013117
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013118ssl_bc : boolean
13119 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13120 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13121 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13122
13123ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13124 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13125 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13126
13127ssl_bc_cipher : string
13128 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13129 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13130
13131ssl_bc_protocol : string
13132 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13133 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13134
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013135ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013136 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013137 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13138 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013139
13140ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13141 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13142 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13143 if session was reused or not.
13144
13145ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13146 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13147 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013149ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13150 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13151 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13152 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13153 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13154 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13157 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13158 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13159 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13160 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013161
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013162ssl_c_der : binary
13163 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13164 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13165 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013167ssl_c_err : integer
13168 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13169 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13170 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13171 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13172 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13175 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13176 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13177 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13178 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13179 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13180 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13181 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13182 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013184ssl_c_key_alg : string
13185 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13186 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13187 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013189ssl_c_notafter : string
13190 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13191 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13192 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013194ssl_c_notbefore : string
13195 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13196 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13197 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013199ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13200 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13201 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13202 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13203 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13204 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13205 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13206 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13207 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013209ssl_c_serial : binary
13210 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13211 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13212 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013214ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13215 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13216 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13217 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013218 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13219 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13220
13221 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013223ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13224 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13225 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13226 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013228ssl_c_used : boolean
13229 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13230 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013232ssl_c_verify : integer
13233 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13234 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13235 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13236 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013238ssl_c_version : integer
13239 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13240 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013241
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013242ssl_f_der : binary
13243 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13244 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13245 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013247ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13248 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13249 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13250 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13251 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013252 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013253 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13254 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13255 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013257ssl_f_key_alg : string
13258 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13259 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13260 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013262ssl_f_notafter : string
13263 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13264 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13265 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013267ssl_f_notbefore : string
13268 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13269 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13270 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013272ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13273 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13274 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13275 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13276 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13277 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13278 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13279 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13280 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013282ssl_f_serial : binary
13283 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13284 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13285 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013286
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013287ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13288 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13289 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13290 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013292ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13293 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13294 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13295 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013297ssl_f_version : integer
13298 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13299 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13300
13301ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013302 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13303 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13304 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013306 Example :
13307 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13308 listen http-https
13309 bind :80
13310 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13311 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13312
13313ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13314 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13315 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13316
13317ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013318 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013319 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13320 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13321 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13322 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13323 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13324 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13325 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13326 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013328ssl_fc_cipher : string
13329 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13330 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013332ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013333 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13334 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013335 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13336 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13337 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13338 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13341 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013342 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13343 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13344 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13345 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013346
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013347ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013348 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13349 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013352 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013353 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13354 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13355 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13356 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13357 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13358 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13359 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013361ssl_fc_protocol : string
13362 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13363 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013364
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013365ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013366 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013367 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13368 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13371 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13372 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13373 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13374 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013376ssl_fc_sni : string
13377 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13378 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13379 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13380 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13381 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13382
13383 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13384 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13385 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013386 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13387 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013389 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13391 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013393ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13394 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13395 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013396
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013397
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133987.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013399------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013401Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13402sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13403only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13404For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13405be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13406can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13407sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13408for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13409content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013411payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13412 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13413 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13414 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013416payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13417 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13418 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13419 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013421req.len : integer
13422req_len : integer (deprecated)
13423 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13424 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13425 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13426 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13427 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13428 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13429 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13430 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013432req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13433 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013434 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13435 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13436 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13437 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439 ACL alternatives :
13440 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013442req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13443 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13444 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13445 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13446 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013448 ACL alternatives :
13449 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013451 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013453req.proto_http : boolean
13454req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13455 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13456 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13457 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13458 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13459 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13460 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13461 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013463 Example:
13464 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13465 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13466 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013467 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013469req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13470rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13471 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13472 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13473 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13474 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13475 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13476 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13477 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013479 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13480 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13481 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13482 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13483 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13484 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013486 ACL derivatives :
13487 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013489 Example :
13490 listen tse-farm
13491 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13492 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13493 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13494 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13495 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13496 persist rdp-cookie
13497 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13498 # This is only useful makes sense if
13499 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13500 stick-table type string size 204800
13501 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13502 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13503 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13506 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013508req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13509rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13510 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13511 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13512 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13513 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013515 ACL derivatives :
13516 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013517
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013518req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13519 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13520 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013521 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13522 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13523 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13524 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13525 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013527req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13528req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13529 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13530 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13531 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13532 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13533 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13534 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13535 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537req.ssl_sni : string
13538req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13539 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13540 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13541 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13542 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13543 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13544 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13545 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13546 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13547 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13548 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13549 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13550 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013552 ACL derivatives :
13553 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013555 Examples :
13556 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13557 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13558 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13559 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13560 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013561
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013562req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13563 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13564 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13565 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13566 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13567 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13568 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13569 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13570 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13571 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013573req.ssl_ver : integer
13574req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13575 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13576 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13577 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13578 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13579 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13580 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13581 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13582 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13583 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013585 ACL derivatives :
13586 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013587
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013588res.len : integer
13589 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13590 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13591 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13592 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13593 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13594 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13595 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13596 content inspection.
13597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013598res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13599 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013600 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13601 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13602 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13603 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013605res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13606 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13607 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13608 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13609 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013611 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013612
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013613res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13614rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13615 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13616 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13617 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13618 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13619 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13620 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13621 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623wait_end : boolean
13624 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13625 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13626 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13627 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13628 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13629 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13630 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13631 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013633 Examples :
13634 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13635 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13636 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013638 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13639 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13640 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13641 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13642 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13643 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13644 tcp-request content reject
13645
13646
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136477.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013648--------------------------------------
13649
13650It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13651This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13652data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13653its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13654HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13655content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13656to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13657more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13658response are indexed.
13659
13660base : string
13661 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13662 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13663 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13664 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13665 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13666 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13667 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13668 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13669
13670 ACL derivatives :
13671 base : exact string match
13672 base_beg : prefix match
13673 base_dir : subdir match
13674 base_dom : domain match
13675 base_end : suffix match
13676 base_len : length match
13677 base_reg : regex match
13678 base_sub : substring match
13679
13680base32 : integer
13681 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13682 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13683 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013684 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13685 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13686 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013687
13688base32+src : binary
13689 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13690 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13691 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13692 per-URL counters.
13693
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013694capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13695 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13696 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13697 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13698
13699capture.req.method : string
13700 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13701 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13702 because it's allocated.
13703
13704capture.req.uri : string
13705 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13706 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13707 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13708 allocated.
13709
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013710capture.req.ver : string
13711 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13712 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13713 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13714
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013715capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13716 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13717 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13718 The first entry is an index of 0.
13719 See also: "capture response header"
13720
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013721capture.res.ver : string
13722 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13723 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13724 persistent flag.
13725
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013726req.body : binary
13727 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13728 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13729 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13730 the first chunk is analyzed.
13731
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013732req.body_param([<name>) : string
13733 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13734 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13735 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13736 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13737 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13738 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13739 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13740 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13741 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13742 given.
13743
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013744req.body_len : integer
13745 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13746 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13747 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13748 "option http-buffer-request".
13749
13750req.body_size : integer
13751 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13752 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13753 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13754 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13755 "option http-buffer-request".
13756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013757req.cook([<name>]) : string
13758cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13759 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13760 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13761 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13762 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13763 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13764 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13765 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13766 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13767
13768 ACL derivatives :
13769 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13770 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13771 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13772 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13773 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13774 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13775 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13776 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013778req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13779cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13780 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13781 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013783req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13784cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13785 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13786 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13787 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13788 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13791 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13792 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13793 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13794 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013795 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013796 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13797 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13798 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13799 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013801hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13802 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13803 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13804 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13805 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013806 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013808req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13809 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13810 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13811 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13812 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13813 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13814 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13815 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13816 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013818req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13819 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13820 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13821 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13822 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013824req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13825 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13826 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13827 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13828 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13829 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13830 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13831 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13832 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13833 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13834 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13835 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013837 ACL derivatives :
13838 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13839 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13840 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13841 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13842 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13843 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13844 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13845 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13846
13847req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13848hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13849 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13850 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13851 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13852 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13853 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13854 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13855 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13856 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13857 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13858
13859req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13860hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13861 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13862 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13863 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13864 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13865 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13866 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13867 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13868 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13869
13870req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13871hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13872 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13873 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13874 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13875 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13876 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13877 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13878 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13879
13880http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13881 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13882 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13883 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13884 basic auth is supported.
13885
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013886http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13887 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13888 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13889 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13890 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013891 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13892 basic auth is supported.
13893
13894 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013895 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13896 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13897 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13898 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013899
13900http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013901 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13902 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013903 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13904 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013906method : integer + string
13907 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13908 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13909 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13910 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13911 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13912 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13913 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013915 ACL derivatives :
13916 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013918 Example :
13919 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13920 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13921 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013923path : string
13924 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13925 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13926 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13927 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13928 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13929 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13930 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013932 ACL derivatives :
13933 path : exact string match
13934 path_beg : prefix match
13935 path_dir : subdir match
13936 path_dom : domain match
13937 path_end : suffix match
13938 path_len : length match
13939 path_reg : regex match
13940 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013941
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013942query : string
13943 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13944 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13945 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13946 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13947 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13948 which stops before the question mark.
13949
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013950req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13951 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13952 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13953 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13954 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013956req.ver : string
13957req_ver : string (deprecated)
13958 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13959 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13960 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013962 ACL derivatives :
13963 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013965res.comp : boolean
13966 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13967 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13968 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013970res.comp_algo : string
13971 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13972 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13973 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013975res.cook([<name>]) : string
13976scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13977 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13978 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13979 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013981 ACL derivatives :
13982 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013984res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13985scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13986 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13987 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13988 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013990res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13991scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13992 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13993 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13994 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013996res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13997 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13998 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13999 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14000 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14001 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14002 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14003 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14004 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14005 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014007res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14008 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14009 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14010 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14011 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14012 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014014res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14015shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14016 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14017 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14018 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14019 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14020 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14021 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14022 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14023 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014025 ACL derivatives :
14026 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14027 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14028 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14029 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14030 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14031 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14032 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14033 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14034
14035res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14036shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14037 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14038 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14039 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14040 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14041 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14044shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14045 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14046 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14047 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14048 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14049 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14050 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014051
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014052res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14053 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14054 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14055 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14056 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014058res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14059shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14060 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14061 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14062 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14063 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14064 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14065 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014067res.ver : string
14068resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14069 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14070 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014072 ACL derivatives :
14073 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014075set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14076 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14077 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014078 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014079 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014081 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14082 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084status : integer
14085 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14086 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14087 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014088
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014089unique-id : string
14090 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14091 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14092 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14093 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14094 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14095 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014097url : string
14098 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14099 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14100 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14101 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14102 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14103 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14104 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014106 ACL derivatives :
14107 url : exact string match
14108 url_beg : prefix match
14109 url_dir : subdir match
14110 url_dom : domain match
14111 url_end : suffix match
14112 url_len : length match
14113 url_reg : regex match
14114 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014116url_ip : ip
14117 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14118 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14119 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14120 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14121 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14122 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14123 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125url_port : integer
14126 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14127 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14128 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14129 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014130
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014131urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14132url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014133 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14134 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014135 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14136 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14137 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14138 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014139 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14140 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014141 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14142 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144 ACL derivatives :
14145 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14146 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14147 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14148 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14149 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14150 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14151 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14152 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014153
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014155 Example :
14156 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14157 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14158 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14159 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014160
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014161urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014162 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14163 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14164 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014165
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014166url32 : integer
14167 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14168 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14169 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14170 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14171 is an unsigned integer.
14172
14173url32+src : binary
14174 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14175 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14176 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14177
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200141797.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014180---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014182Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14183every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014184order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014186ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14187---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014188FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014189HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014190HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14191HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014192HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14193HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14194HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14195HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14196LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014197METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014198METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014199METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14200METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14201METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14202METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014203METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014204METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014205RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014206REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014207TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014208WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14209---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014210
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142128. Logging
14213----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014214
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014215One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14216provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14217very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14218provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14219state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014220to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014221headers.
14222
14223In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14224about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14225send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14226
14227 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14228 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14229 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14230 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14231 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014232 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14233 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014234
14235The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14236allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14237as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14238while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14239real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14240delay.
14241
14242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142438.1. Log levels
14244---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014245
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014246TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014247source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014248HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14249in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14250track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14251syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14252about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014253
14254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142558.2. Log formats
14256----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014257
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014258HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014259and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14260slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14261options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014262
14263 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14264 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14265 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14266 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14267 extents.
14268
14269 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14270 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14271 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14272 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14273 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14274
14275 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14276 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14277 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14278 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14279 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14280
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014281 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14282 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14283 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14284 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14285
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014286 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14287
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014288Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14289specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14290field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14291servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14292always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14293identifier.
14294
14295Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14296 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14297 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14298 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14299 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14300
14301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143028.2.1. Default log format
14303-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014304
14305This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14306as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14307format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14308
14309 Example :
14310 listen www
14311 mode http
14312 log global
14313 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14314
14315 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14316 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14317 (www/HTTP)
14318
14319 Field Format Extract from the example above
14320 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14321 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14322 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14323 4 'to' to
14324 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14325 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14326
14327Detailed fields description :
14328 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14329 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14330 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14331 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14332 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14333 and processed the connection.
14334 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14335
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014336In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14337"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14338connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14339
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014340It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14341will eventually disappear.
14342
14343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143448.2.2. TCP log format
14345---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014346
14347The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14348is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14349information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14350counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14351emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14352environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14353the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14354sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014355specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14356not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14357fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14358marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014359
14360 Example :
14361 frontend fnt
14362 mode tcp
14363 option tcplog
14364 log global
14365 default_backend bck
14366
14367 backend bck
14368 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14369
14370 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14371 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14372 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14373
14374 Field Format Extract from the example above
14375 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14376 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14377 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14378 4 frontend_name fnt
14379 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14380 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14381 7 bytes_read* 212
14382 8 termination_state --
14383 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14384 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14385
14386Detailed fields description :
14387 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014388 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14389 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14390 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014391 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14392 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14393 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014394
14395 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014396 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14397 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14398 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014399
14400 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14401 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14402 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14403 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14404
14405 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14406 and processed the connection.
14407
14408 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14409 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14410 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14411 applications.
14412
14413 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14414 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14415 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14416 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14417 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14418
14419 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14420 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14421 See "Timers" below for more details.
14422
14423 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14424 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14425 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14426 "Timers" below for more details.
14427
14428 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014429 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014430 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14431 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14432 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14433 details.
14434
14435 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14436 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14437 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14438 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14439 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14440
14441 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14442 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14443 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14444 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14445 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14446 for more details.
14447
14448 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014449 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014450 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14451 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14452 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014453 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014454
14455 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14456 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14457 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14458 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14459 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14460 caused by a denial of service attack.
14461
14462 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14463 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14464 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14465 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14466 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14467 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14468 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14469 denial of service attack.
14470
14471 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14472 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14473 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14474 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14475 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14476 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14477 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14478 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14479 be processed than on other servers.
14480
14481 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14482 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14483 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14484 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14485 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14486 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14487 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14488 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14489 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14490 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14491 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14492 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14493 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14494
14495 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14496 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14497 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14498 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14499 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14500 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14501 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14502 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14503
14504 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14505 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14506 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14507 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14508 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14509 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14510 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14511 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14512 occurs.
14513
14514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145158.2.3. HTTP log format
14516----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014517
14518The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14519is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14520the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14521are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14522emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14523generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14524"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14525which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014526frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14527is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014528
14529Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14530slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14531with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14532
14533 Example :
14534 frontend http-in
14535 mode http
14536 option httplog
14537 log global
14538 default_backend bck
14539
14540 backend static
14541 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14542
14543 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14544 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14545 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014546 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014547
14548 Field Format Extract from the example above
14549 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14550 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14551 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14552 4 frontend_name http-in
14553 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14554 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14555 7 status_code 200
14556 8 bytes_read* 2750
14557 9 captured_request_cookie -
14558 10 captured_response_cookie -
14559 11 termination_state ----
14560 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14561 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14562 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14563 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14564 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014565
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014566
14567Detailed fields description :
14568 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014569 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14570 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14571 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014572 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14573 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14574 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014575
14576 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014577 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14578 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14579 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014580
14581 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14582 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14583 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14584 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14585 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14586
14587 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14588 and processed the connection.
14589
14590 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14591 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14592 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14593
14594 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14595 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14596 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14597 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14598 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14599 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14600
14601 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14602 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14603 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14604 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14605 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14606 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14607
14608 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14609 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14610 See "Timers" below for more details.
14611
14612 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14613 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14614 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14615 below for more details.
14616
14617 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14618 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14619 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14620 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14621 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14622 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14623 for more details.
14624
14625 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014626 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014627 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14628 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14629 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14630 details.
14631
14632 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14633 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14634 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14635
14636 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14637 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14638 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14639 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14640 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14641 overflowing.
14642
14643 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14644 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14645 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14646 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14647 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14648 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14649 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14650 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14651
14652 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14653 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14654 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14655 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14656 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14657 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14658 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14659 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14660
14661 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14662 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14663 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14664 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14665 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14666 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14667 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14668
14669 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014670 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014671 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14672 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14673 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014674 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014675 system.
14676
14677 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14678 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14679 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14680 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14681 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14682 caused by a denial of service attack.
14683
14684 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14685 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14686 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14687 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14688 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14689 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14690 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14691 denial of service attack.
14692
14693 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14694 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14695 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14696 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14697 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14698 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14699 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14700 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14701 processed than on other servers.
14702
14703 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14704 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14705 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14706 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14707 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14708 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14709 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14710 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14711 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14712 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14713 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14714 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14715 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14716
14717 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14718 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14719 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14720 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14721 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14722 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14723 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14724 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14725
14726 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14727 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14728 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14729 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14730 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14731 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14732 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14733 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14734 occurs.
14735
14736 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14737 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14738 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14739 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14740 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14741 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14742 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14743 cookies" below for more details.
14744
14745 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14746 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14747 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14748 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14749 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14750 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14751 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14752 and cookies" below for more details.
14753
14754 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14755 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14756 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14757 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14758 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14759 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14760 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14761 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14762
14763
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200147648.2.4. Custom log format
14765------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014766
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014767The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014768mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014769
14770HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14771Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14772separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14773prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14774
14775Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14776variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014777("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014778
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014779If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014780as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014781less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14782the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14783
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014784Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014785In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014786in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014787
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014788Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14789'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14790https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14791such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14792
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014793Flags are :
14794 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014795 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014796 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14797 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014798
14799 Example:
14800
14801 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14802 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14803
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014804 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
14805
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014806At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14807
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014808 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14809 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014810
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014811the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014812
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014813 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014814 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014815 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014816
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014817and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14818
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014819 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014820 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14821
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014822Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14823
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014824 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014825 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014826 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14827 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14828 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014829 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14830 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14831 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014832 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014833 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14834 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014835 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014836 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14837 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014838 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014839 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014840 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014841 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020014842 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014843 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014844 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14845 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014846 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014847 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14848 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014849 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014850 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14851 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014852 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14853 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14854 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014855 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014856 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14857 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014858 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014859 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14860 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14861 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014862 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014863 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014864 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14865 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14866 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14867 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014868 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014869 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014870 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014871 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014872 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014873 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014874 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14875 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14876 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014877 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014878 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14879 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014880 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014881 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014882 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014883 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014884
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014885 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014886
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014887
148888.2.5. Error log format
14889-----------------------
14890
14891When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14892protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14893By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14894"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14895will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14896logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14897
14898The format looks like this :
14899
14900 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14901 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14902 Connection error during SSL handshake
14903
14904 Field Format Extract from the example above
14905 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14906 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14907 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14908 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14909 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14910
14911These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14912failures.
14913
14914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149158.3. Advanced logging options
14916-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014917
14918Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14919just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14920options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14921for more information about their usage.
14922
14923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149248.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14925------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014926
14927It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14928haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14929commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14930monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14931ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14932
14933 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14934 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14935 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14936 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14937
14938 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14939 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14940 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014941 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014942 such as other load-balancers.
14943
14944 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14945 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14946 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14947
14948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149498.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14950----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014951
14952The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14953what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14954or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14955"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14956just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14957log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14958after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14959is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14960with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14961with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14962
14963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149648.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14965------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014966
14967Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14968for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14969"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14970retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14971raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14972a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14973file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14974you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14975"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14976
14977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149788.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14979--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014980
14981Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14982multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14983them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14984"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14985logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14986error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14987and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14988too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14989useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14990alternative.
14991
14992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149938.4. Timing events
14994------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014995
14996Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14997reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14998the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14999frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
15000mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
15001
15002 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15003 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
15004 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
15005 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
15006 the client closes prematurely or times out.
15007
15008 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15009 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15010 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15011 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15012 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15013
15014 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15015 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15016 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15017 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15018 connection never established.
15019
15020 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15021 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15022 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15023 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15024 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15025 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15026 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15027 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15028 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15029 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15030 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15031
15032 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15033 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
15034 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
15035 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015036 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015037
15038 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15039
15040 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
15041 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
15042 negative.
15043
15044These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15045protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15046that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015047due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015048close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
15049session has been aborted on timeout.
15050
15051Most common cases :
15052
15053 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15054 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
15055 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
15056 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
15057 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
15058 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
15059 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
15060 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
15061 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010015062 connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive modes
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015063 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
15064 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015065
15066 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15067 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15068 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15069 of ms on remote networks.
15070
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015071 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15072 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15073 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015074
15075 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15076 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
15077 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
15078 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
15079 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
15080 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
15081 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
15082 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
15083 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
15084 to the server until another one is released.
15085
15086Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15087
15088 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
15089 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
15090 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
15091
15092 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
15093 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15094 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15095
15096 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
15097 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15098 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15099 flags.
15100
15101 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15102 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
15103 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15104 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15105 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15106 the client connection was maintained open.
15107
15108 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015109 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015110 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
15111 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15112
15113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151148.5. Session state at disconnection
15115-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015116
15117TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15118"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
151192-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15120each of which has a special meaning :
15121
15122 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15123 session to terminate :
15124
15125 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15126
15127 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15128 server explicitly refused it.
15129
15130 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15131 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15132 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15133 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015134 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15135
15136 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15137 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015138
15139 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15140 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15141 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15142 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15143 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15144
15145 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15146 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15147 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15148 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15149 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15150
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015151 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15152 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15153
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015154 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15155 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15156 backup connections when going up.
15157
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015158 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15159
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015160 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15161 send or receive data.
15162
15163 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15164 send or receive data.
15165
15166 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15167 with nothing left in the buffers.
15168
15169 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15170
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015171 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015172 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15173
15174 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15175 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15176 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15177 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15178 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15179
15180 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15181 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15182
15183 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15184 server (HTTP only).
15185
15186 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15187
15188 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15189 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15190 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15191
15192 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15193 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15194 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15195
15196 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15197
15198 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15199 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15200
15201 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15202 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15203 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15204
15205 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15206 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015207 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15208 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015209
15210 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15211 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15212 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15213 another server.
15214
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015215 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015216 server.
15217
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015218 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15219 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15220 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15221 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15222
15223 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15224 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15225 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15226 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15227
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015228 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15229 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15230 "use-server" rule).
15231
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015232 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15233
15234 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15235 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15236
15237 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15238
15239 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15240 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15241 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15242
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015243 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15244 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015245 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015246 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15247 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15248
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015249 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15250
15251 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15252 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15253
15254 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15255
15256 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15257
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015258The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15259was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015260helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15261starvation, attacks, etc...
15262
15263The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15264alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15265easier finding and understanding.
15266
15267 Flags Reason
15268
15269 -- Normal termination.
15270
15271 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15272 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15273 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15274 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15275
15276 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15277 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15278 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15279 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15280 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15281 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015282
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015283 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15284 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015285 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015286
15287 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15288 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15289 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15290
15291 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15292 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15293 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15294 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15295 the server takes too long to respond.
15296
15297 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15298 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15299 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15300 long a time to respond.
15301
15302 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15303 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15304 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15305 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015306 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15307 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015308
15309 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15310 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15311 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15312 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15313 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015314 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015315 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15316 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15317 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15318 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15319 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15320 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15321 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15322 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15323 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15324 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15325 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15326 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015327
15328 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15329 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015330 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15331 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15332 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15333 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015334
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015335 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15336 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015338 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015339 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15340 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15341 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15342 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15343 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15344
15345 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15346 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15347 503 or 504 here.
15348
15349 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15350 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15351 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15352 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15353 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15354
15355 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15356 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015357 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015358 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15359 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15360
15361 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15362 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15363 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15364 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15365 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15366 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15367 between haproxy and the server.
15368
15369 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15370 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15371 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15372 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15373 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15374 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15375 solution is to fix the application.
15376
15377 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15378 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15379 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15380 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15381 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15382 external attacks.
15383
15384 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15385 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015386 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015387 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15388 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15389
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015390 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15391 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15392 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015393 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15394 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015396 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15397 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15398 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15399 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015400 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15401 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15402 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15403 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15404 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015405
15406 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15407 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15408 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15409 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15410
15411 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15412 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15413 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15414 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15415
15416 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15417 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15418 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15419 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15420
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015421The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15422persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15423important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15424re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15425
15426 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15427
15428 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15429 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15430 set on a GET request.
15431
15432 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15433 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015434 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015435 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15436
15437 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15438 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15439 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15440
15441 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15442 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15443 already got a cookie.
15444
15445 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15446 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15447 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15448 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15449 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15450
15451 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15452 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15453 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15454
15455 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15456 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15457 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15458
15459 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15460 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15461
15462 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15463 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15464 then advertised in the response.
15465
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154678.6. Non-printable characters
15468-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015469
15470In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15471consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15472converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15473prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15474being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15475escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15476is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15477'}' when logging headers.
15478
15479Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15480issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15481containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15482
15483Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15484the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15485performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15486
15487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15489---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015490
15491Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15492achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015493section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015494cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15495the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15496the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015497locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015498not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15499user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15500a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15501wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15502
15503 Examples :
15504 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15505 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15506
15507 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15508 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15509
15510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15512---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015513
15514Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15515proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15516the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15517server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15518
15519Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15520response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015521section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015522
15523It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015524time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15525appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015526are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15527and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15528follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15529request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15530in the logs.
15531
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015532As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15533frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15534an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15535
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015536 Example :
15537 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15538 listen proxy-out
15539 mode http
15540 option httplog
15541 option logasap
15542 log global
15543 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15544
15545 # log the name of the virtual server
15546 capture request header Host len 20
15547
15548 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15549 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15550
15551 # log the beginning of the referrer
15552 capture request header Referer len 20
15553
15554 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15555 capture response header Server len 20
15556
15557 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15558 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15559
15560 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15561 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15562
15563 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15564 capture response header Via len 20
15565
15566 # log the URL location during a redirection
15567 capture response header Location len 20
15568
15569 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15570 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15571 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15572 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15573 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15574
15575 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15576 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15577 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15578 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015579 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015580
15581 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15582 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15583 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15584 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15585 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015586 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015587
15588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155898.9. Examples of logs
15590---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015591
15592These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15593them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15594reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15595
15596 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15597 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15598 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15599
15600 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15601 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15602
15603 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15604 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15605 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15606
15607 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15608 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15609
15610 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15611 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15612 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15613
15614 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015615 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015616 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15617 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15618
15619 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15620 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15621 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15622
15623 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15624 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015625 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015626 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15627 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15628 to return the 502 and not the server.
15629
15630 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015631 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015632
15633 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15634 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15635 Nothing was sent to any server.
15636
15637 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15638 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15639
15640 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15641 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15642 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15643 send a 408 return code to the client.
15644
15645 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15646 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15647
15648 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15649 5 seconds ("c----").
15650
15651 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15652 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015653 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015654
15655 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015656 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015657 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15658 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15659 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15660 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15661 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015662
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015663
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200156649. Supported filters
15665--------------------
15666
15667Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
15668accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
15669unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
15670
15671See also : "filter"
15672
156739.1. Trace
15674----------
15675
15676filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
15677
15678 Arguments:
15679 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
15680 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
15681
15682 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
15683 the client and the server. By default, this filter
15684 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
15685 only parses a random amount of the available data.
15686
15687 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
15688 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
15689 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
15690 amount of the parsed data.
15691
15692This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
15693callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
15694information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
15695filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
15696
15697Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
15698tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
15699a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
15700
15701
157029.2. HTTP compression
15703---------------------
15704
15705filter compression
15706
15707The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
15708keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
15709when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
15710use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
15711used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
15712filters evaluation order.
15713
15714See also : "compression"
15715
15716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015717/*
15718 * Local variables:
15719 * fill-column: 79
15720 * End:
15721 */